L 60 MCC 8
L 60 MCC 8
Project Guide
Camshaft Controlled
Twostroke Engines
This Project Guide is intended to provide the information necessary for the layout of a marine
propulsion plant.
The information is to be considered as preliminary. It is intended for the project stage only and
subject to modification in the interest of technical progress. The Project Guide provides the gen-
eral technical data available at the date of issue.
It should be noted that all figures, values, measurements or information about performance
stated in this project guide are for guidance only and should not be used for detailed design
purposes or as a substitute for specific drawings and instructions prepared for such purposes.
Data updates
Data not finally calculated at the time of issue is marked ‘Available on request’. Such data may
be made available at a later date, however, for a specific project the data can be requested.
Pages and table entries marked ‘Not applicable’ represent an option, function or selection which
is not valid.
The latest, most current version of the individual Project Guide sections are available on the In-
ternet at: www.mandiesel.com under ‘Marine’ → ‘Low Speed’.
Extent of Delivery
The final and binding design and outlines are to be supplied by our licensee, the engine maker,
see Chapter 20 of this Project Guide.
In order to facilitate negotiations between the yard, the engine maker and the customer, a set of
‘Extent of Delivery’ forms is available in which the basic and the optional executions are specified.
Electronic versions
This Project Guide book and the ‘Extent of Delivery’ forms are available on a DVD and can also
be found on the Internet at: www.mandiesel.com under ‘Marine’ → ‘Low Speed’, where they can
be downloaded.
1st Edition
January 2009
Copyright © 2008 MAN Diesel, branch of MAN Diesel SE, Germany, registered with the Danish Commerce and
Companies Agency under CVR Nr.: 31611792, (herein referred to as “MAN Diesel”).
This document is the product and property of MAN Diesel and is protected by applicable copyright laws.
Subject to modification in the interest of technical progress. Reproduction permitted provided source is given.
7020-0063-00ppr Jan 2009
Engine Design......................................................................... 01
Engine Layout and Load Diagrams, SFOC .............................. 02
Turbocharger Choice & Exhaust Gas By-pass ......................... 03
Electricity Production ............................................................. 04
Installation Aspects................................................................. 05
List of Capacities: Pumps, Coolers & Exhaust Gas .................. 06
Fuel ....................................................................................... 07
Lubricating Oil ....................................................................... 08
Cylinder Lubrication . ............................................................. 09
Piston Rod Stuffing Box Drain Oil ........................................... 10
Central Cooling Water System . .............................................. 11
Seawater Cooling .................................................................. 12
Starting and Control Air . ........................................................ 13
Scavenge Air ......................................................................... 14
Exhaust Gas .......................................................................... 15
Engine Control System . ......................................................... 16
Vibration Aspects ................................................................... 17
Monitoring Systems and Instrumentation ............................... 18
Dispatch Pattern, Testing, Spares and Tools ........................... 19
Project Support and Documentation . ..................................... 20
Appendix ............................................................................... A
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Contents
Chapter Section
1 Engine Design
The MC/MC-C Engine 1.01 1985628-9.0
Engine type designation 1.02 1985521-0.0
Power, speed, SFOC 1.03 1985537-8.0
Engine power range and fuel oil consumption 1.04 1985556-9.0
Performance curves, fuel economy mode / low NOx emission mode 1.05 1985572-4.0
MC Engine description 1.06 1985590-3.1
Engine cross section 1.07 1985608-6.0
2 Engine Layout and Load Diagrams, SFOC
Engine layout and load diagrams 2.01 1983833-8.4
Propeller diameter and pitch, influence on optimum propeller speed 2.02 1983878-2.5
Layout diagram, sizes 2.03 1985309-1.0
Engine layout diagram and load diagrams 2.04 1986032-6.1
Diagram for actual project 2.05 1984159-8.2
Specific fuel oil consumption, ME versus MC engines 2.06 1985310-1.0
SFOC for high efficiency/conventional turbochargers 2.07 1986042-2.0
SFOC, reference conditions and guarantee 2.08 1986044-6.0
SFOC calculations (80%-85%) 2.09 1986107-1.0
SFOC calculations, example 2.10 1986105-8.0
Fuel consumption at an arbitrary load 2.11 1986631-7.0
Emission control 2.12 1986636-6.0
3 Turbocharger Choice & Exhaust Gas By-pass
Turbocharger choice 3.01 1985676-7.0
Exhaust gas by-pass 3.02 1984593-4.4
NOx Reduction by SCR 3.03 1985894-7.1
4 Electricity Production
Electricity production 4.01 1985740-2.0
Designation of PTO 4.01 1986634-2.0
PTO/RCF 4.01 1984300-0.2
Space requirements for side mounted PTO/RCF 4.02 1984313-2.1
Engine preparations 4.03 1984315-6.2
PTO/BW GCR 4.04 1984316-8.5
Waste Heat Recovery Systems (WHR) 4.05 1986647-4.0
L16/24 Genset data 4.06 1984205-4.4
L21/31 Genset data 4.07 1984206-6.4
L23/30H Genset data 4.08 1984207-8.4
L27/38 Genset data 4.09 1984209-1.4
L28/32H Genset data 4.10 1984210-1.4
Chapter Section
5 Installation Aspects
Space requirements and overhaul heights 5.01 1984375-4.4
Space requirement 5.02 1985980-9.0
Crane beam for overhaul of turbochargers 5.03 1984500-1.3
Crane beam for turbochargers 5.03 1984848-8.0
Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler 5.03 1984851-1.0
Engine room crane 5.04 1985750-9.0
Overhaul with Double Jib Crane 5.04 1984534-8.2
Double jib crane 5.04 1984541-9.1
Engine outline, galleries and pipe connections 5.05 1984715-8.3
Engine and gallery outline 5.06 1986610-2.0
Centre of gravity 5.07 1985704-4.0
Water and oil in engine 5.08 1985677-9.0
Engine pipe connections 5.09 1986465-2.0
Counterflanges 5.10 1986536-0.0
Counterflanges, Connection D 5.10 1986670-0.0
Engine seating and holding down bolts 5.11 1984176-5.5
Epoxy Chocks Arrangement 5.12 1984189-7.1
Engine seating profile 5.12 1984202-9.1
Engine top bracing 5.13 1984672-5.7
Mechanical top bracing 5.14 1986007-6.0
Hydraulic top bracing arrangement 5.15 1986025-5.0
Components for Engine Control System 5.16 1986030-2.0
Earthing device 5.17 1984929-2.3
MAN Diesel Controllable Pitch Propeller (CPP) 5.18 1984695-3.4
6 List of Capacities: Pumps, Coolers & Exhaust Gas
Calculation of capacities 6.01 1986166-8.0
List of capacities and cooling water systems 6.02 1985042-8.3
List of capacities, L60MC-C8 6.03 1986249-6.0
Auxiliary system capacities for derated engines 6.04 1986426-9.0
Pump capacities, pressures and flow velocities 6.04 1986194-3.0
Example 1, Pumps and Cooler Capacity 6.04 1986293-7.0
Freshwater generator 6.04 1986173-9.0
Jacket Cooling Water Temperature Control 6.04 1986375-3.0
Example 2, Fresh Water Production 6.04 1986294-9.0
Calculation of exhaust gas amount and temperature 6.04 1986176-4.0
Diagram for change of exhaust gas amount 6.04 1986177-6.0
Exhaust gas correction formula 6.04 1984320-3.3
Example 3, Expected Exhaust Gas 6.04 1986295-0.0
7 Fuel
Fuel oil system 7.01 1985639-7.1
Fuel considerations 7.01 1986778-0.0
Fuel oils 7.02 1983880-4.5
Fuel oil pipes and drain pipes 7.03 1985905-7.0
Fuel oil pipe insulation 7.04 1984051-8.3
Components for fuel oil system 7.05 1983951-2.3
Components for fuel oil system, venting box 7.05 1984735-0.1
Water in fuel emulsification 7.06 1983882-8.3
Chapter Section
8 Lubricating Oil
Lubricating and cooling oil system 8.01 1985636-1.0
Hydraulic power supply unit 8.02 1985637-3.0
Lubricating oil pipes for turbochargers 8.03 1984232-8.3
Lubricating oil centrifuges and list of lubricating oils 8.04 1983886-5.5
Components for lube oil system 8.05 1984242-4.4
Lubricating oil tank 8.06 1984256-8.1
Crankcase venting and bedplate drain pipes 8.07 1985926-1.0
9 Cylinder Lubrication
Cylinder lubricating oil system 9.01 1986612-6.0
MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system 9.02 1985632-4.0
Mechanical Cylinder Lubricators 9.03 1985968-0.0
Oil Supply System 9.03 1986598-2.0
10 Piston Rod Stuffing Box Drain Oil
Stuffing box drain oil system 10.01 1983974-0.4
11 Central Cooling Water System
Central cooling water system 11.01-02 1984696-5.3
Components for central cooling water system 11.03 1983987-2.3
12 Seawater Cooling
Seawater Systems 12.01 1983892-4.4
Seawater cooling system 12.02 1983893-6.4
Seawater cooling pipes 12.03 1983978-8.4
Components for seawater cooling system 12.04 1983981-1.3
Jacket cooling water system 12.05 1983894-8.5
Jacket cooling water pipes 12.06 1983984-7.5
Components for jacket cooling water system 12.07 1984056-7.3
Deaerating tank 12.07 1984063-8.2
Temperature at start of engine 12.08 1983986-0.2
13 Starting and Control Air
Starting and control air system 13.01 1986052-9.0
Components for starting air system 13.02 1986048-3.0
Starting and control air pipes 13.03 1986060-1.0
Electric motor for turning gear 13.04 1984138-3.1
14 Scavenge Air
Scavenge air system 14.01 1984005-3.2
Auxiliary blowers 14.02 1986586-2.1
Operational panel for auxiliary blowers 14.02 1986587-4.0
Scavenge air pipes 14.03 1986161-9.0
Electric motor for auxiliary blower 14.04 1986216-1.0
Scavenge air cooler cleaning system 14.05 1984019-7.1
Scavenge air box drain system 14.06 1985403-6.1
Fire extinguishing system for scavenge air space 14.07 1984042-3.2
Chapter Section
15 Exhaust Gas
Exhaust gas system 15.01 1984046-0.3
Exhaust gas pipes 15.02 1986402-9.0
Cleaning systems, MAN Diesel 15.02 1984071-0.4
Cleaning systems, ABB and Mitsubishi 15.02 1984073-4.5
Exhaust gas system for main engine 15.03 1984074-6.3
Components of the exhaust gas system 15.04 1984075-8.6
Exhaust gas silencer 15.04 1984092-5.1
Calculation of exhaust gas back-pressure 15.05 1984094-9.3
Forces and moments at turbocharger 15.06 1984067-5.1
Diameter of exhaust gas pipe 15.07 1986502-4.0
16 Engine Control System
Engine control system MC/MC-C 16.01 1985634-8.0
Controllable Pitch Propeller 16.02 1986640-1.0
Engine Control System Interface to Surrounding Systems 16.03 1986641-3.0
17 Vibration Aspects
Vibration aspects 17.01 1984140-5.2
2nd order moments on 5 or 6 cylinder engines 17.02 1986644-9.0
Electric driven moment compensator 17.03 1984222-1.3
Power related unbalance (PRU) 17.04 1985870-7.0
Guide force moments 17.05 1984223-3.3
Guide force moments, data 17.05 1985904-5.0
Axial vibrations 17.06 1984225-7.4
Critical running 17.06 1984226-9.2
External forces and moments in layout points, L60MC-C8 17.07 1985942-7.0
18 Monitoring Systems and Instrumentation
Monitoring systems and instrumentation 18.01 1986233-9.0
PMI System 18.02 1986234-0.0
CoCoS-EDS 18.03 1986235-2.0
Alarm - Slow Down and Shut Down System 18.04 1986236-4.0
Local instruments 18.05 1986237-6.0
Other alarm functions 18.06 1986238-8.0
Identification of Instruments 18.07 1984585-1.4
19 Dispatch Pattern, Testing, Spares and Tools
Dispatch pattern, testing, spares and tools 19.01 1986642-5.0
Specification for painting of main engine 19.02 1984516-9.2
Dispatch Pattern 19.03 1986562-2.0
Dispatch pattern, list of masses and dimensions 19.04 1986574-2.0
Shop test 19.05 1984612-7.4
List of spare parts, unrestricted service 19.06 1985594-9.5
Additional spares 19.07 1984636-7.5
Wearing parts 19.08 1985185-4.1
Large spare parts, dimension and masses 19.09 1984665-4.2
List of standard tools for maintenance 19.10 1986450-7.0
Tool panels 19.11 1986645-0.0
Chapter Section
20 Project Support and Documentation
Engine Selection Guide and Project Guide 20.01 1984588-7.3
Computerised engine application system 20.02 1984590-9.2
Extent of Delivery 20.03 1984591-0.2
Installation documentation 20.04 1984592-2.2
A Appendix
Symbols for piping A 1983866-2.3
Section
2nd order moments on 5 or 6 cylinder engines 17.02 1986644-9.0
A
Additional spares 19.07 1984636-7.5
Alarm - Slow Down and Shut Down System 18.04 1986236-4.0
Auxiliary blowers 14.02 1986586-2.1
Auxiliary system capacities for derated engines 6.04 1986426-9.0
Axial vibrations 17.06 1984225-7.4
C
Calculation of capacities 6.01 1986166-8.0
Calculation of exhaust gas amount and temperature 6.04 1986176-4.0
Calculation of exhaust gas back-pressure 15.05 1984094-9.3
Central cooling water system 11.01-02 1984696-5.3
Centre of gravity 5.07 1985704-4.0
Cleaning systems, ABB and Mitsubishi 15.02 1984073-4.5
Cleaning systems, MAN Diesel 15.02 1984071-0.4
CoCoS-EDS 18.03 1986235-2.0
Components for central cooling water system 11.03 1983987-2.3
Components for Engine Control System 5.16 1986030-2.0
Components for fuel oil system 7.05 1983951-2.3
Components for fuel oil system, venting box 7.05 1984735-0.1
Components for jacket cooling water system 12.07 1984056-7.3
Components for lube oil system 8.05 1984242-4.4
Components for seawater cooling system 12.04 1983981-1.3
Components for starting air system 13.02 1986048-3.0
Components of the exhaust gas system 15.04 1984075-8.6
Computerised engine application system 20.02 1984590-9.2
Controllable Pitch Propeller 16.02 1986640-1.0
Counterflanges 5.10 1986536-0.0
Counterflanges, Connection D 5.10 1986670-0.0
Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler 5.03 1984851-1.0
Crane beam for overhaul of turbochargers 5.03 1984500-1.3
Crane beam for turbochargers 5.03 1984848-8.0
Crankcase venting and bedplate drain pipes 8.07 1985926-1.0
Critical running 17.06 1984226-9.2
Cylinder lubricating oil system 9.01 1986612-6.0
D
Deaerating tank 12.07 1984063-8.2
Designation of PTO 4.01 1986634-2.0
Diagram for actual project 2.05 1984159-8.2
Diagram for change of exhaust gas amount 6.04 1986177-6.0
Diameter of exhaust gas pipe 15.07 1986502-4.0
Dispatch Pattern 19.03 1986562-2.0
Dispatch pattern, list of masses and dimensions 19.04 1986574-2.0
Dispatch pattern, testing, spares and tools 19.01 1986642-5.0
Double jib crane 5.04 1984541-9.1
Section
E
Earthing device 5.17 1984929-2.3
Electric driven moment compensator 17.03 1984222-1.3
Electric motor for auxiliary blower 14.04 1986216-1.0
Electric motor for turning gear 13.04 1984138-3.1
Electricity production 4.01 1985740-2.0
Emission control 2.12 1986636-6.0
Engine and gallery outline 5.06 1986610-2.0
Engine Control System Interface to Surrounding Systems 16.03 1986641-3.0
Engine control system MC/MC-C 16.01 1985634-8.0
Engine cross section 1.07 1985608-6.0
Engine layout and load diagrams 2.01 1983833-8.4
Engine layout diagram and load diagrams 2.04 1986032-6.1
Engine outline, galleries and pipe connections 5.05 1984715-8.3
Engine pipe connections 5.09 1986465-2.0
Engine power range and fuel oil consumption 1.04 1985556-9.0
Engine preparations 4.03 1984315-6.2
Engine room crane 5.04 1985750-9.0
Engine seating and holding down bolts 5.11 1984176-5.5
Engine seating profile 5.12 1984202-9.1
Engine Selection Guide and Project Guide 20.01 1984588-7.3
Engine top bracing 5.13 1984672-5.7
Engine type designation 1.02 1985521-0.0
Epoxy Chocks Arrangement 5.12 1984189-7.1
Example 1, Pumps and Cooler Capacity 6.04 1986293-7.0
Example 2, Fresh Water Production 6.04 1986294-9.0
Example 3, Expected Exhaust Gas 6.04 1986295-0.0
Exhaust gas by-pass 3.02 1984593-4.4
Exhaust gas correction formula 6.04 1984320-3.3
Exhaust gas pipes 15.02 1986402-9.0
Exhaust gas silencer 15.04 1984092-5.1
Exhaust gas system 15.01 1984046-0.3
Exhaust gas system for main engine 15.03 1984074-6.3
Extent of Delivery 20.03 1984591-0.2
External forces and moments in layout points, L60MC-C8 17.07 1985942-7.0
F
Fire extinguishing system for scavenge air space 14.07 1984042-3.2
Forces and moments at turbocharger 15.06 1984067-5.1
Freshwater generator 6.04 1986173-9.0
Fuel considerations 7.01 1986778-0.0
Fuel consumption at an arbitrary load 2.11 1986631-7.0
Fuel oil pipe insulation 7.04 1984051-8.3
Fuel oil pipes and drain pipes 7.03 1985905-7.0
Fuel oil system 7.01 1985639-7.1
Fuel oils 7.02 1983880-4.5
G
Guide force moments 17.05 1984223-3.3
Guide force moments, data 17.05 1985904-5.0
Section
H
Hydraulic power supply unit 8.02 1985637-3.0
Hydraulic top bracing arrangement 5.15 1986025-5.0
I
Identification of Instruments 18.07 1984585-1.4
Installation documentation 20.04 1984592-2.2
J
Jacket cooling water pipes 12.06 1983984-7.5
Jacket cooling water system 12.05 1983894-8.5
Jacket Cooling Water Temperature Control 6.04 1986375-3.0
L
L16/24 Genset data 4.06 1984205-4.4
L21/31 Genset data 4.07 1984206-6.4
L23/30H Genset data 4.08 1984207-8.4
L27/38 Genset data 4.09 1984209-1.4
L28/32H Genset data 4.10 1984210-1.4
Large spare parts, dimension and masses 19.09 1984665-4.2
Layout diagram, sizes 2.03 1985309-1.0
List of capacities and cooling water systems 6.02 1985042-8.3
List of capacities, L60MC-C8 6.03 1986249-6.0
List of spare parts, unrestricted service 19.06 1985594-9.5
List of standard tools for maintenance 19.10 1986450-7.0
Local instruments 18.05 1986237-6.0
Lubricating and cooling oil system 8.01 1985636-1.0
Lubricating oil centrifuges and list of lubricating oils 8.04 1983886-5.5
Lubricating oil pipes for turbochargers 8.03 1984232-8.3
Lubricating oil tank 8.06 1984256-8.1
M
MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system 9.02 1985632-4.0
MAN Diesel Controllable Pitch Propeller (CPP) 5.18 1985322-1.1
MC Engine description 1.06 1985590-3.1
Mechanical Cylinder Lubricators 9.03 1985968-0.0
Mechanical top bracing 5.14 1986007-6.0
Monitoring systems and instrumentation 18.01 1986233-9.0
N
NOx Reduction by SCR 3.03 1985894-7.1
O
Oil Supply System 9.03 1986598-2.0
Operational panel for auxiliary blowers 14.02 1986587-4.0
Other alarm functions 18.06 1986238-8.0
Overhaul with Double Jib Crane 5.04 1984534-8.2
Section
P
Performance curves, fuel economy mode / low NOx emission mode 1.05 1985572-4.0
PMI System 18.02 1986234-0.0
Power related unbalance (PRU) 17.04 1985870-7.0
Power, speed, SFOC 1.03 1985537-8.0
Propeller diameter and pitch, influence on optimum propeller speed 2.02 1983878-2.5
PTO/BW GCR 4.04 1984316-8.5
PTO/RCF 4.01 1984300-0.2
Pump capacities, pressures and flow velocities 6.04 1986194-3.0
S
Scavenge air box drain system 14.06 1985403-6.1
Scavenge air cooler cleaning system 14.05 1984019-7.1
Scavenge air pipes 14.03 1986161-9.0
Scavenge air system 14.01 1984005-3.2
Seawater cooling pipes 12.03 1983978-8.4
Seawater cooling system 12.02 1983893-6.4
Seawater Systems 12.01 1983892-4.4
SFOC calculations (80%-85%) 2.09 1986107-1.0
SFOC calculations, example 2.10 1986105-8.0
SFOC for high efficiency/conventional turbochargers 2.07 1986042-2.0
SFOC, reference conditions and guarantee 2.08 1986044-6.0
Shop test 19.05 1984612-7.4
Space requirement 5.02 1985980-9.0
Space requirements and overhaul heights 5.01 1984375-4.4
Space requirements for side mounted PTO/RCF 4.02 1984313-2.1
Specific fuel oil consumption, ME versus MC engines 2.06 1985310-1.0
Specification for painting of main engine 19.02 1984516-9.2
Starting and control air pipes 13.03 1986060-1.0
Starting and control air system 13.01 1986052-9.0
Stuffing box drain oil system 10.01 1983974-0.4
Symbols for piping A 1983866-2.3
T
Temperature at start of engine 12.08 1983986-0.2
The MC/MC-C Engine 1.01 1985628-9.0
Tool panels 19.11 1986645-0.0
Turbocharger choice 3.01 1985676-7.0
V
Vibration aspects 17.01 1984140-5.2
W
Waste Heat Recovery Systems (WHR) 4.05 1986647-4.0
Water and oil in engine 5.08 1985677-9.0
Water in fuel emulsification 7.06 1983882-8.3
Wearing parts 19.08 1985185-4.1
Engine Design
1
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 1.01
Page of 1
Whether the freight rates rise or fall, an attractive Each cylinder is equipped with its own fuel injec-
payback time for newbuildings starts with low in- tion pump, which consists of a simple plunger ac-
vestment cost. Once in operation, the ease and tivated by the fuel cam directly. Fuel economy at
flexibility in assigning engineers to operate the part load is optimized by means of the Variable
engine plant are together with low consumption Injection Timing (VIT) incorporated in the fuel
rates of fuels, lubes, parts and service among the pumps (optional on certain MC-C engines).
important functional issues which contribute to
the cost benefit. The MAN B&W MC/MC-C engine The cam controlled exhaust valve is opened hy-
meets both requirements. draulically and closed by means of an air spring.
The world market-leading two-stroke MC/MC-C Lubrication is either by means of a uni-lube oil
engine programme from MAN Diesel has evolved system serving both crankshaft, chain drive, pis-
since the early 1980s to embrace bore sizes from ton cooling and camshaft or a combination of a
260 mm to 980 mm for propelling ocean-going main lubricating oil system and a separate cam-
ships of all types and sizes. In fact, low-speed shaft lube oil system.
two-stroke main engines of the MC/MC-C type
have become industry standard in a huge number Cylinder lubrication is accomplished by electroni-
of ship types. Also land-based applications (pow- cally controlled Alpha lubricators, securing a low
er plants mainly) have found the MC/MC-C engine lube oil consumption, or timed mechanical lubri-
types attractive. cators alternatively.
The MC/MC-C engine features chain driven cam- The starting valves are opened pneumatically by
shaft, camshaft controlled fuel injection timing control air from the starting air distributor(s) and
and exhaust valve opening as well as a conven- closed by a spring.
tional fuel oil pumps, all well-known and proven
technology familiar to marine engineers all over The MC-C engine is the shorter, more com-
the world. pact version of the MC engine. It is well suited
wherever a small engine room is requested, for in-
To conclude, the MAN B&W MC/MC-C engine stance in container vessels.
combines classic virtues of commonly known,
well-proven technology continuously upgraded The main features of the MC engine are described
and up-rated to suit the requirements to modern in the following pages.
prime movers. Consequently, our latest cutting
edge design and manufacturing features are built For further information about the application of
into each component. MC/MC-C engines based on ship particulars and
power demand, please refer to our publications
titled:
Concept of the MC/MC-C engine
Propulsion Trends in Container Vessels
The engine concept is based on a mechanical
camshaft system for activation of the fuel injec- Propulsion Trends in Bulk Carriers
tion and the exhaust valves. The engine is pro-
vided with a pneumatic/electric manoeuvring sys- Propulsion Trends in Tankers
tem and the engine speed is controlled by an
electronic/hydraulic type governor. The publications are available at:
www.mandiesel.com under
‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers’
6 S 70 M CC 7
Mark version
Engine programme
Diameter of piston in cm
Number of cylinders
0OWER
Power, Speed, Fuel and Lubricating Oil Consumption
,
3PEED
178 50 064.0
0OWER
,
Power and speed
, ,
Mean Power kW
Engine effective ,
Number of cylinders
Layout speed pressure
points r/min bar 5 6 7 8 9
L1 123 20.0 11,700 14,040 16,380 18,720 21,060
L2 123 16.0 9,400 11,280 13,160 15,040 16,9203PEED
L3 105 20.0 10,000 12,000 14,000 16,000 18,000
L4 105 16.0 8,000 9,600 11,200 12,800 14,400
The following tables contain data regarding the Specific fuel oil consumption (SFOC)
power, speed and specific fuel oil consumption of
the engine. Specific fuel oil consumption values refer to brake
power, and the following reference conditions:
Engine power is specified in kW for each cylinder
number and layout points L1, L 2, L3 and L4. ISO 3046/12002:
Blower inlet temperature.................................. 25°C
Discrepancies between kW and metric horsepow- Blower inlet pressure..............................1000 mbar
er (1 BHP = 75 kpm/s = 0.7355 kW) are a conse- Charge air coolant temperature...................... 25 °C
quence of the rounding off of the BHP values. Fuel oil lower calorific value................ 42,700 kJ/kg
(~10,200 kcal/kg)
L1 designates nominal maximum continuous rating
(nominal MCR), at 100% engine power and 100% Although the engine will develop the power speci-
engine speed. fied up to tropical ambient conditions, specific
fuel oil consumption varies with ambient condi-
L 2, L3 and L4 designate layout points at the other tions and fuel oil lower calorific value. For calcula-
three corners of the layout area, chosen for easy tion of these changes, see Chapter 2.
reference.
0OWER , SFOC guarantee
Overload corresponds to 110% of the power at The guarantee is given with a margin of 5%.
MCR, and may be permitted for a limited period of
one hour every 12 hours. As SFOC and NOx are interrelated parameters, an
engine offered without fulfilling the IMO NOx limi-
The engine power figures given in the tables re- tations is subject to a tolerance of only 3% of the
main valid up to tropical conditions at sea level as SFOC.
stated in IACS M28 (1978), i.e.:
Performance Curves
RPM
BAR
%NGINEæ3PEED
-%0
BARæABS
-EANæEFFECTIVEæPRESSURE
#YLæ0RESSURE
BARæABS
-AXIMUMæPRESSURE
0SCAV
DEG#
#OMPRESSIONæPRESSURE
3CAVENGEæAIRæPRESSURE
%XHæ'ASæ4EMP
%XHAUSTæGASæTEMPERATURE
INLETæTOæTURBOCHARGER
%XHAUSTæGASæTEMPERATURE
OUTLETæFROMæTURBOCHARGER
GK7H
3PECIFICæFUELæOIL
3&/#
CONSUMPTION
178 58 70-1.0
RPM
BAR
%NGINEæ3PEED
-%0
BARæABS
-EANæEFFECTIVEæPRESSURE
#YLæ0RESSURE
BARæABS
-AXIMUMæPRESSURE
0SCAV
DEG#
#OMPRESSIONæPRESSURE
3CAVENGEæAIRæPRESSURE
%XHæ'ASæ4EMP
%XHAUSTæGASæTEMPERATURE
INLETæTOæTURBOCHARGER
%XHAUSTæGASæTEMPERATURE
OUTLETæFROMæTURBOCHARGER
GK7H
3PECIFICæFUELæOIL
3&/#
CONSUMPTION
178 58 71-3.0
MC Engine Description
The cylinder liner is made of alloyed cast iron The propeller thrust is transferred through the
and is suspended in the cylinder frame with a thrust collar, the segments, and the bedplate, to
lowsituated flange. The top of the cylinder liner is the end chocks and engine seating, and thus to
fitted with a cooling jacket. the ship’s hull.
The cylinder liner has scavenge ports, drilled The thrust bearing is located in the aft end of the
holes for cylinder lubrication and is prepared for engine. The thrust bearing is of the B&WMichell
installation of temperature sensors, if required. type, and consists primarily of a thrust collar on
the crankshaft, a bearing support, and segments
of steel lined with white metal.
Cylinder Cover
Engines type 60 and larger with 9 cylinders or
The cylinder cover is of forged steel, made in one more will be specified with the 360º degree type
piece, and has bores for cooling water. It has a thrust bearing, while the 240º degree type is used
central bore for the exhaust valve, and bores for in all other engines. MAN Diesel’s flexible thrust
the fuel valves, a starting valve and an indicator cam design is used for the thrust collar on a range
valve. of engine types. The thrust shaft is an integrated
part of the crankshaft and lubricated by the en-
The cylinder cover is attached to the cylinder gine’s lubricating oil system.
frame with studs and nuts tightened with hydrau-
lic jacks.
Turning Gear and Turning Wheel
The piston is made as an integrated collar on the whereas the other three piston rings all have an
main crank journal, and the housing is fixed to oblique cut. All four rings are alu-coated on the
the main bearing support. For functional check of outer surface for running-in.
the vibration damper a mechanical guide is fitted,
while an electronic vibration monitor can be sup- The piston skirt is made of cast iron with a bronze
plied as an option. band.
Piston
Scavenge Air Cooler
The piston consists of a piston crown and piston
skirt. The piston crown is made of heatresistant For each turbocharger a scavenge air cooler of
steel. A piston cleaning ring located in the very the monoblock type is fitted. The cooler is de-
top of the cylinder liner scrapes off excessive ash signed as a central cooling system cooled by
and carbon formations on the piston topland. freshwater of maximum 4.5 bar working pressure.
Alternatively, a seawater cooling system with up to
The piston has four ring grooves which are 2.0 2.5 bar working pressure can be chosen.
hardchrome plated on both the upper and lower
surfaces of the grooves. The uppermost piston The scavenge air cooler is so designed that the
ring is of the Controlled Pressure Relief type (CPR), difference between the scavenge air temperature
and the water inlet temperature at specified MCR
can be kept at about 12 °C.
The engine is provided with electricallydriven The camshaft consists of a number of sections
scavenge air blowers. The suction side of the each having a shaft piece with exhaust cams, fuel
blowers is connected to the scavenge air space cams, coupling parts and indicator drive cams.
after the air cooler.
The exhaust cams and fuel cams are made of
Between the air cooler and the scavenge air receiv- steel, with a hardened roller race, and are shrunk
er, nonreturn valves are fitted which automatically onto the shaft. They can be adjusted and disman-
close when the auxiliary blowers supply the air. tled hydraulically.
The auxiliary blowers will start operating con- The cam for the indicator drive can be adjusted
secutively before the engine is started in order to mechanically. The coupling parts are shrunk onto
ensure sufficient scavenge air pressure to obtain the shaft and can be adjusted and dismantled hy-
a safe start. draulically.
Further information is given in Chapter 14. The camshaft bearings consist of one lower half-
shell fitted in a bearing support. The camshaft is
lubricated by the main lubricating oil system.
Exhaust Gas System
From the exhaust valves, exhaust gas is led to the Chain Drive
exhaust gas receiver where the fluctuating pres-
sure from the individual cylinders is equalised, The camshaft is driven from the crankshaft by a
and the total volume of gas is led further on to the chain drive, which is kept running tight by a manu-
turbocharger(s). After the turbocharger(s), the gas ally adjusted chain tightener. The long free lengths
is led to the external exhaust pipe system. of chain are supported by rubber-clad guidebars
and the chain is lubricated through oil spray pipes
Compensators are fitted between the exhaust fitted at the chain wheels and guidebars.
valves and the receiver, and between the receiver
and the turbocharger(s). The mechanical cylinder lubricators, if fitted, are
driven from the camshaft by a separate chain.
The exhaust gas receiver and exhaust pipes are
provided with insulation, covered by galvanised
steel plating. Indicator Drive
A protective grating is installed between the ex- As separate options, the engine can be supplied
haust gas receiver and the turbocharger. with either an indicator drive, a mechanical indica-
tor system, or the so-called PMI system, a pres-
sure analyser system, described in section 18.02.
Exhaust Turbocharger
The indicator drive consists of a cam fitted on the
The engines can be fitted with either MAN Diesel, camshaft and a springloaded spindle with a roller
ABB or Mitsubishi turbochargers. which moves up and down in accordance with the
movement of the piston within the engine cylinder.
The turbocharger choice is described in Chapter At the top, the spindle has an eye to which the
3, and the exhaust gas system in Chapter 15. indicator cord is fastened after the indicator has
been installed on the indicator valve.
The engine is to be provided with a governor of Each cylinder cover is equipped with two or three
a make approved by MAN Diesel, controlling the fuel valves, starting air valve (SAV), and indicator
fuel pump through an actuator. The governor must valve.
meet the ISO 3046 standard, part IV, 1997.
The opening of the fuel valves is controlled by the
The speed setting of the actuator is determined by high fuel oil pressure created by the fuel oil pump,
an electronic signal from the electronic governor and the valves are closed by a spring. The fuel
based on the position of the main engine regulat- valves are cooled by the fuel.
ing handle. The actuator is connected to the fuel
regulating shaft by means of a mechanical linkage. An automatic vent slide allows circulation of fuel
oil through the valve and high pressure pipes
when the engine is stopped. The vent slide also
Fuel Oil Pump and prevents the compression chamber from being
Fuel Oil High Pressure Pipes filled up with fuel oil in the event that the valve
spindle sticks. Oil from the vent slide and other
The engine is provided with one fuel pump for drains is led away in a closed system.
each cylinder. The fuel pump consists of a pump
housing of nodular cast iron, a centrally placed The starting air valve is opened by control air
pump barrel, and a plunger of nitrated steel. In from the starting air distributor and is closed by a
order to prevent fuel oil from mixing with the lu- spring. The control air supply is regulated so that
bricating oil, the pump actuator is provided with a the starting valves deliver starting air to the cylin-
sealing arrangement. ders in the correct firing order.
Exhaust Valve
The exhaust valve consists of the valve housing The regulating system makes it possible to start,
and the valve spindle. The valve housing is made stop, reverse the engine and control the engine
of cast iron and is arranged for water cooling. The speed. The speed control on the manoeuvring
housing is provided with a water cooled bottom console gives a speedsetting signal to the gover-
piece of steel with a flame-hardened seat of the nor, dependent on the desired number of revolu-
W-seat design. The exhaust valve spindle is a tions.
Dura Spindle or made of Nimonic. The housing is
provided with a spindle guide. At shut-down, the fuel injection is stopped by the
puncture valves in the fuel pumps being activated,
The exhaust valve is tightened to the cylinder cov- independently of the speed control. At reversing,
er with studs and nuts. It is opened hydraulically the displaceable rollers in the driving mechanism
and closed by means of air pressure. The hydrau- for the fuel pumps are moved to the ‘Astern’ posi-
lic system consists of a piston actuator placed tion by air cylinders controlled by the starting air
on the roller guide housing, a highpressure pipe, distributor.
and a working cylinder on the exhaust valve. The
piston actuator is activated by a cam on the cam- The engine is provided with an engine side
shaft. mounted console and instrument panel.
Piping Arrangements
• Fuel oil
• Heating of fuel oil pipes
• Lubricating oil, piston cooling oil and
camshaft lubrication
• Cylinder lubricating oil
• Cooling water to scavenge air cooler
• Jacket and turbocharger cooling water
• Cleaning of scavenge air cooler
• Cleaning of turbocharger
• Fire extinguishing in scavenge air space
• Starting air
• Control air
• Safety air
• Oil mist detector
• Various drain pipes.
178 22 70-5.1
2
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 2.01
Page of 2
P = c x pe x n
i=2
so, for constant mep, the power is proportional to
the speed:
Fig. 2.01.01 shows the relationship for the linear Propulsion and Engine Running Points
functions, y = ax + b, using linear scales.
Propeller curve
The power functions P = c x ni will be linear func-
tions when using logarithmic scales: The relation between power and propeller speed
for a fixed pitch propeller is as mentioned above
log (P) = i x log (n) + log (c) described by means of the propeller law, i.e. the
y third power curve:
P = c x n3, in which:
a
Propeller design point
placed on the light running propeller curve 6. See the socalled sea margin, which is traditionally
below figure. On the other hand, some shipyards, about 15% of the propeller design (PD) power.
and/or propeller manufacturers sometimes use a
propeller design point (PD) that incorporates all or Engine layout (heavy propeller)
part of the socalled sea margin described below.
When determining the necessary engine layout
Power, % af L speed that considers the influence of a heavy run-
00%
= 0,20
= 0,5 L ning propeller for operating at high extra ship resis-
= 0,25 = 0,30
tance, it is (compared to line 6) recommended to
choose a heavier propeller line 2. The propeller
L3 MP
curve for clean hull and calm weather line 6 may
Engine margin
(SP=90% of MP)
SP
PD
then be said to represent a ‘light running’ (LR)
Sea margin
L2 (5% of PD) propeller.
PD
In general, the larger the propeller diameter D, Once an optimum propeller diameter of maximum
the lower is the optimum propeller speed and the 7.2 m has been chosen, the corresponding op-
kW required for a certain design draught and ship timum pitch in this point is given for the design
speed, see curve D in the figure below. speed of 14.5 knots, i.e. P/D = 0.70.
The maximum possible propeller diameter de- However, if the optimum propeller speed of 100
pends on the given design draught of the ship, r/min does not suit the preferred / selected main
and the clearance needed between the propeller engine speed, a change of pitch away from opti-
and the aft body hull and the keel. mum will only cause a relatively small extra power
demand, keeping the same maximum propeller
The example shown in the figure is an 80,000 dwt diameter:
crude oil tanker with a design draught of 12.2 m
and a design speed of 14.5 knots. • going from 100 to 110 r/min (P/D = 0.62) requires
8,900 kW i.e. an extra power demand of 80 kW.
When the optimum propeller diameter D is in-
creased from 6.6 m to 7.2. m, the power demand • going from 100 to 91 r/min (P/D = 0.81) requires
is reduced from about 9,290 kW to 8,820 kW, and 8,900 kW i.e. an extra power demand of 80 kW.
the optimum propeller speed is reduced from 120
r/min to 100 r/min, corresponding to the constant In both cases the extra power demand is only
ship speed coefficient ∝ = 0.28 (see definition of of 0.9%, and the corresponding ‘equal speed
∝ in section 2.02, page 2). curves’ are ∝ =+0.1 and ∝ =0.1, respectively, so
there is a certain interval of propeller speeds in
which the ‘power penalty’ is very limited.
3HAFTæPOWER
K7
$ææ/PTIMUMæPROPELLERæDIAMETERS
0$ææ0ITCHDIAMETERæRATIO
$ 0$
M
0$
M
M
M
M
$
0ROPELLER
SPEED
RMIN
178 47 032.0
The constant ship speed lines ∝, are shown at area and parallel to one of the ∝lines, another
the very top of Fig. 2.02.02. These lines indicate specified propulsion MCR point ‘MP2’ upon this
the power required at various propeller speeds to line can be chosen to give the ship the same
keep the same ship speed provided that the op- speed for the new combination of engine power
timum propeller diameter with an optimum pitch and speed.
diameter ratio is used at any given speed, taking
into consideration the total propulsion efficiency. Fig. 2.02.02 shows an example of the required
power speed point MP1, through which a constant
Normally, the following relation between neces- ship speed curve ∝= 0.25 is drawn, obtaining
sary power and propeller speed can be assumed: point MP2 with a lower engine power and a lower
engine speed but achieving the same ship speed.
P2 = P1 x (n2 /n1)∝
Provided the optimum pitch/diameter ratio is used
where: for a given propeller diameter the following data
P = Propulsion power applies when changing the propeller diameter:
n = Propeller speed, and
∝= the constant ship speed coefficient. for general cargo, bulk carriers and tankers
∝= 0.25 0.30
For any combination of power and speed, each
point on lines parallel to the ship speed lines gives and for reefers and container vessels
the same ship speed. ∝= 0.15 0.25
When such a constant ship speed line is drawn When changing the propeller speed by changing
into the layout diagram through a specified pro- the pitch diameter ratio, the ∝ constant will be dif-
pulsion MCR point ‘MP1’, selected in the layout ferent, see above.
Power
0%
=0,5
speed lines
=0,20
=0,25 Constant ship 00%
=0,30
90%
MP
=0,25 80%
MP2
3
me p
% 70%
00
95%
90%
2
85% 60%
80%
75%
70% 50%
40%
An engine’s layout diagram is limited by two con- Optimising point (O) = specified MCR (M)
stant mean effective pressure (mep) lines L1– L3 for engine without VIT
and L2– L4, and by two constant engine speed In its basic design the engine type is not fitted
lines L1– L2 and L3 – L4. The L1 point refers to the with VIT fuel pumps, so the specified MCR is the
engine’s nominal maximum continuous rating, see point at which the engine is optimised – point M
Fig. 2.01.03. coincides with point O.
In the layout area, the engine’s specified MCR Optimising point (O) for engine with VIT
point M can be set freely to suit the ship’s de- The engine can be fitted with VIT fuel pumps,
mand for propeller power and speed. option: 4 35 104, in order to improve the SFOC.
On the horizontal axis and on the vertical axis the The optimising point O is placed on line 1 of the
engine speed and the engine power are shown, load diagram, see below, and the optimised pow-
respectively, on percentage scales. The scales er can be from 85% to 100% of point M’s power,
are logarithmic which means that, in this diagram, when turbocharger(s) and engine timing are taken
power function curves like propeller curves (3rd into consideration. When optimising between 85%
power), constant mean effective pressure curves and 100% of point M’s power, overload running
(1st power) and constant ship speed curves (0.15 will still be possible (110% of M).
to 0.30 power) are straight lines.
The optimising point O is to be placed inside the
Specified maximum continuous rating (M) layout diagram. In fact, the specified MCR point M
Based on the propulsion and engine running can, in special cases, be placed outside the lay-
points, found previously, the layout diagram of a out diagram, but only by exceeding line L1-L2, and
relevant main engine may be drawnin. The speci- of course, only provided that the optimising point
fied MCR point (M) must be inside the limitation O is located inside the layout diagram, and that
lines of the layout diagram; if it is not, the propel- the MCR power is not higher than the L1 power.
ler speed must be changed or another main en-
gine type chosen. Yet, in special cases, point M
may be located to the right of the line L1-L2, see Engine Load Diagram
‘Optimising point’ below.
Definitions
Continuous service rating (S)
The continuous service rating is the power need- The engine’s load diagram defines the power and
ed in service - including the specified sea margin speed limits for continuous as well as overload op-
and heavy/light running factor of the propeller eration of an installed engine having an optimising
- at which the engine is to operate at the required point O and a specified MCR point M that confirms
design ship speed, and point S is identical to the the specification of the ship.
service propulsion point (SP) unless a main en-
gine driven shaft generator is installed. Point A is a 100% speed and power reference
point of the load diagram, and is defined as the
Optimising point (O) point on the propeller curve (line 1), through the
The optimising point O is the rating at which the optimising point O, having the specified MCR
turbocharger is matched, and at which the engine power. Normally, point M is equal to point A, but
timing and compression ratio are adjusted. in special cases, for example if a shaft generator
is installed, point M may be placed to the right of
point A on line 7.
60
Line 3 and line 9:
55
Line 3 represents the maximum acceptable speed 8 4 1 6 3
for continuous operation, i.e. 105% of A. 50
2 9
45
If, in special cases, A is located to the right of line
L1-L2, the maximum limit is, however, 105% of L1. 40
60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110
Engine speed, % of A
During trial conditions, the maximum speed may 178 39 18-4.1
Recommendation
Extended load diagram for ships operating in extreme heavy running conditions
When a ship with fixed pitch propeller is operat- Extended load diagram for speed derated en-
ing in normal sea service, it will in general be gines with increased light running
operating in the hatched area around the design
propeller curve 6, as shown on the standard load The maximum speed limit (line 3) of the engines is
diagram in Fig. 2.04.01. 105% of the SMCR (Specified Maximum Continu-
ous Rating) speed, as shown in Fig. 2.04.01.
Sometimes, when operating in heavy weather, the
fixed pitch propeller performance will be more However, for speed and, thereby, power derated
heavy running, i.e. for equal power absorption of engines it is possible to extend the maximum
the propeller, the propeller speed will be lower speed limit to 105% of the engine’s nominal MCR
and the propeller curve will move to the left. speed, line 3’, but only provided that the torsional
vibration conditions permit this. Thus, the shaft-
As the low speed main engines are directly cou- ing, with regard to torsional vibrations, has to be
pled to the propeller, the engine has to follow the approved by the classification society in question,
propeller performance, i.e. also in heavy running based on the extended maximum speed limit.
propeller situations. For this type of operation,
there is normally enough margin in the load area When choosing an increased light running to be
between line 6 and the normal torque/speed limi- used for the design of the propeller, the load dia-
tation line 4, see Fig. 2.04.01. To the left of line 4 in gram area may be extended from line 3 to line 3’,
torquerich operation, the engine will lack air from as shown in Fig. 2.04.02, and the propeller/main
the turbocharger to the combustion process, i.e. engine operating curve 6 may have a correspond-
the heat load limits may be exceeded and bearing ingly increased heavy running margin before ex-
loads might also become too high. ceeding the torque/speed limit, line 4.
For some special ships and operating conditions, A corresponding slight reduction of the propel-
it would be an advantage when occasionally ler efficiency may be the result, due to the higher
needed to be able to operate the propeller/main propeller design speed used.
engine as much as possible to the left of line 6,
but inside the torque/speed limit, line 4.
Fig. 2.04.02: Extended load diagram for speed derated • Example 4 shows a special case with a shaft gen-
engine with increased light running erator. In this case, the shaft generator is cut off,
and the gensets used when the engine runs at
specified MCR. This makes it possible to choose a
smaller engine with a lower power output.
, , !/--0
!/--0
, , !/-
!/-
330 ,,
330
3 3
, , , ,
, , 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
, , 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
178 39 20-6.0
0OWERææOFæ,
0OWERææOFæ,
With VIT 0OWERææOFæ,
0OWERææOFæ,
! !!
!
, ,
, ,
, , !--0
!--0
/ /
, , !-!-
/ /
330 ,,
330
3 3
, , , ,
, , 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
, , 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
178 55 82-5.0
M Specified MCR of engine Point A of the load diagram is found:
S Continuous service rating of engine Line 1 Propeller curve through optimising point (O)
O Optimising point of engine is equal to line 2
A Reference point of load diagram Line 7 Constant power line through specified MCR (M)
MP Specified MCR for propulsion Point A Intersection between line 1 and 7
SP Continuous service rating of propulsion
For engines without VIT, the optimising point O will have the Point A is then found at the intersection between propeller
same power as point M, and its propeller curve 1 for engine curve 1 (2) and the constant power curve through M, line 7.
layout will normally be selected on the engine service curve In this case, point A is equal to point M.
2 (for fouled hull and heavy weather), as shown in the upper
diagram. Once point A has been found in the layout diagram, the load
diagram can be drawn, as shown in the above figure, and
For engines with VIT, the optimising point O and its propeller hence the actual load limitation lines of the diesel engine may
curve 1 will normally be selected on the engine service curve be found by using the inclinations from the construction lines
2, see the lower diagram. and the %-figures stated.
Fig. 2.04.03: Normal running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and without a shaft generator
,, !/
!/
,, !/
!/
--0
--0 -
-
,
,
330
330 33
,,
,,
,, 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
,, 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
178 39 23-1.1
0OWERææOFæ,
0OWERææOFæ, With VIT 0OWERææOFæ,
0OWERææOFæ, ! !
! !
,,
,,
,, !!
,, !!
// --0
--0 -
-
// ,
,
330
330 33
,,
,,
,, 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
,, 0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
0ROPULSIONæANDæENGINE
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
SERVICEæCURVEæFORæFOULED
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
%NGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
178 55 83-7.0
M Specified MCR of engine Point A of the load diagram is found:
S Continuous service rating of engine Line 1 Propeller curve through optimising point (O)
O Optimising point of engine placed to the left of line 2
A Reference point of load diagram Line 7 Constant power line through specified MCR (M)
MP Specified MCR for propulsion Point A Intersection between line 1 and 7
SP Continuous service rating of propulsion
Fig. 2.04.04: Special running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and without a shaft generator
3' -0 -0
%NGINE
SERVICE
30
CURVE 30
, ,
, ,
0ROPULSIONæCURVEæFORæFOULED 0ROPULSIONæCURVEæFORæFOULED
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
3' -0 -0
%NGINE
SERVICE
30
CURVE 30
, ,
, ,
0ROPULSIONæCURVEæFORæFOULED 0ROPULSIONæCURVEæFORæFOULED
HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER HULLæANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
Fig. 2.04.05: Normal running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and with a shaft generator
%NGINE
SERVICE
CURVE
,
,
, 0ROPULSIONæCURVE , 0ROPULSIONæCURVE
FORæFOULEDæHULL FORæFOULEDæHULL
ANDæHEAVYæWEATHER ANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
%NGINE
SERVICE
CURVE
,
,
, 0ROPULSIONæCURVE , 0ROPULSIONæCURVE
FORæFOULEDæHULL FORæFOULEDæHULL
ANDæHEAVYæWEATHER ANDæHEAVYæWEATHER
Fig. 2.04.06: Special running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and with a shaft generator
Also in this special case, a shaft generator is installed but, In choosing the latter solution, the required specified MCR
compared to Example 3, this case has a specified MCR for power can be reduced from point M’ to point M as shown.
propulsion, MP, placed at the top of the layout diagram. Therefore, when running in the upper propulsion power range,
a diesel generator has to take over all or part of the electrical
This involves that the intended specified MCR of the engine power production.
M’ will be placed outside the top of the layout diagram.
However, such a situation will seldom occur, as ships are
One solution could be to choose a larger diesel engine with rather infrequently running in the upper propulsion power
an extra cylinder. However, another and cheaper solution is to range.
reduce the electrical power production of the shaft generator
when running in the upper propulsion power range. Point A, having the highest possible power, is then found at
the intersection of line L1-L3 with line 1, and the correspond-
ing load diagram is drawn. Point M is found on line 7 at MP’s
speed.
Example 5: Engine coupled to controllable pitch propeller (CPP) with or without shaft generator
, !/-
, !-
, / ,
3 3
,
,
, ,
-INæSPEED -AXæSPEED -INæSPEED -AXæSPEED
%NGINEæSPEED %NGINEæSPEED
Fig. 2.04.07: Engine with Controllable Pitch Propeller (CPP), with or without shaft generator
Example 6: Engines running with VIT fuel pumps running at constant speed with controllable pitch
propeller (CPP)
/
In Fig. A, the optimising point O has been placed
correctly, and the stepup gear and the shaft gen-
erator, if installed, may be synchronised on the
constant speed curve through M.
Fig. 2.04.08: Engines running at constant speed with controllable pitch propeller (CPP) 178 19 699.0
!æ !æ
!æ
æ
æ æ
æ
æ
æ
æ æ æ
0OWERææOFæ,ææ
æ
æ
,
æ
, ,æ
æ ,
æ
,
æ
æ
æ
æ æ æ æ æ æ æ æ æ
%NGINEæSæPEEDææOFæ,ææ
178 06 37-5.3
All engine types are as standard fitted with high temperature, if this is needed for the exhaust gas
efficiency turbochargers (EoD option: 4 59 104) boiler.
but can alternatively use conventional turbochar
gers, option: 4 59 107. The matching of the engine and the turbocharging
system is then modified, thus increasing the ex
The high efficiency turbocharger is applied to the haust gas temperature by 20 °C.
engine in the basic design with the view to ob
taining the lowest possible Specific Fuel Oil Con This modification will lead to a 78% reduction in
sumption (SFOC) values, see curve A, Fig. 2.07.01. the exhaust gas amount, and involve an SFOC
penalty of 2 g/kWh, see curve B, Fig. 2.07.01.
With a conventional turbocharger the amount of
air required for combustion purposes can, how
ever, be adjusted to provide a higher exhaust gas
"
æGK7H
#ONVENTIONALæTURBOCHARGER
!
(IGHæEFFICIENCYæTURBOCHARGER
%NGINEæPOWERææOFæOPTIMISINGæPOINTæ/
178 58 08-1.0
Fig. 2.07.01: Example of part load SFOC curves for high efficiency and conventional turbochargers
The SFOC is given in g/kWh based on the The SFOC guarantee refers to the above ISO ref-
reference ambient conditions stated in ISO erence conditions and lower calorific value. It is
3046:2002(E) and ISO 15550:2002(E): guaranteed for the powerspeed combination in
the optimising point (O) and the engine running
• 1,000 mbar ambient air pressure ‘fuel economy mode’ in compliance with IMO NOx
• 25 °C ambient air temperature emission limitations.
• 25 °C scavenge air coolant temperature,
The SFOC guarantee is given with a tolerance
and is related to a fuel oil with a lower calorific of 5%
value of 42,700 kJ/kg (~10,200 kcal/kg).
Any discrepancies between g/kWh and g/BHPh With or without VIT fuel pumps
are a result of the rounding of numbers for the lat-
ter. In its basic design this engine type is fitted with
fuel pumps without Variable Injection Timing (VIT),
For lower calorific values and for ambient condi- so the optimising point ‘O’ then has to be at the
tions that are different from the ISO reference specified MCR power ‘M’.
conditions, the SFOC will be adjusted according
to the conversion factors in the table below. VIT fuel pumps can, however, be fitted as an op-
tion: 4 35 104, and, in that case, they can be op-
With Without timised between 85-100% of the specified MCR,
pmax pmax point ‘M’, as for the other large MC engine types.
adjusted adjusted Engines with VIT fuel pumps can be part-load op-
Parameter Condition SFOC SFOC timised between 85-100% of the specified MCR.
change change change
Scav. air coolant per 10 °C rise + 0.60% + 0.41% To facilitate the graphic calculation of SFOC, we
temperature use the same diagrams b and c for guidance in
both cases, the only difference is the location of
Blower inlet per 10 °C rise + 0.20% + 0.71%
temperature
the optimising point.
Blower inlet per 10 mbar In the part load area from approx. 60-95%, the
pressure rise 0.02% 0.05%
exact SFOC calculated by our computer program
Fuel oil lower rise 1% will result in a slightly improved SFOC compared
calorific value (42,700 kJ/kg) 1.00% 1.00% to engines without VIT fuel pumps.
.OMINALæ3&/#
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
æOFæOPTIMISINGæPOINT
178 55 89-8.0
Fig. 2.09.01
0OWERææOFæ,
LINES
HIPæSPEEDæ
#ONSTANTæS
Diagram b
IN¬, O WE R
MEP
INAL¬ IMIS
E DæP
HE ¬NOM æOPT æç æ ç
¬TO¬T æç
LA TIVE R æç æç
H¬RE OWE æ ç æ ç
K7 E DæP
IN¬G IMIS
¬3& /#¬ æOPT ç æç
ç æ
TIO N¬OF ER ç æ ç æ
UC OW ç æ
2ED E DæP æç æ
æOP TIMIS ç
æç
æç
æ çæç
ææç
.OMINALæPROPELLERæCURVE
3PEEDææOFæ,
178 58 45-1.0
Fig. 2.09.02
LINES
HIPæSPEEDæ
#ONSTANTæS
Diagram b
IN¬, O WE R
MEP
INAL¬ IMIS
E DæP
HE ¬NOM æOPT æç æ ç
¬TO¬T æç
LA TIVE R çæ ç æç
H¬RE OWE æ ç æ
K7 E DæP
IN¬G IMIS
¬3& /#¬ æOPT ç æç
ç æ
TIO N¬OF ER æç æ ç æ
UC OW æç
2ED TIMIS
E DæP ç æç
æOP æç
æç
æ ç æ ç
æææ
.OMINALæPROPELLERæCURVE
3PEEDææOFæ,
178 58 42-6.0
Fig. 2.09.03
0OWERææOFæ,
LINES
HIPæSPEEDæ
#ONSTANTæS
Diagram b
¬, ER
AL¬IN ED æPOW MEP
IN TIMIS
HE ¬NOM æOP æ ç
¬TO¬T
æç
TIVE ç æç
RELA ER æç æç æ
7H¬ æPOW æ ç
¬IN ¬G K IM ISE D
&/ # æOPT æ ç
OF¬3 ç æç
ION¬ æ ç æ
CT WE R æ ç
2ED
U
ISE D
æPO æç
IM ç æç
æOPT
ç æç
æç æ
æç
ææç
.OMINALæPROPELLERæCURVE
3PEEDææOFæ,
178 58 39-2.0
ç
ç
ç
ç
ç
æOFæSPECIFIEDæ-#2
178 58 34-3.0
Fig. 2.10.01: Example of SFOC for derated L60MC-C8 with fixed pitch propeller and high efficiency turbocharger
Once the optimising point (O) of the engine has The SFOC curve through points S2, on the left
been chosen, the specific fuel oil consumption at of point 1, is symmetrical about point 1, i.e. at
an arbitrary point S1, S2 or S3 can be estimated speeds lower than that of point 1, the SFOC will
based on the SFOC at point ‘1’ and ‘2’. also increase.
These SFOC values can be calculated by using The abovementioned method provides only an
the graphs for the relevant engine type for the approximate value. A more precise indication of
propeller curve I and for the constant speed curve the expected SFOC at any load can be calculated
II, giving the SFOC at points 1 and 2, respectively. by using our computer program. This is a service
which is available to our customers on request.
Next the SFOC for point S1 can be calculated as
an interpolation between the SFOC in points ‘1’
and ‘2’, and for point S3 as an extrapolation.
0OWER OF ! -
!-
3 3 3
) ))
198 95 962.2
Emission Control
All MC and MC-C engines are, as standard, deliv- Water emulsification of the heavy fuel oil is a well
ered in compliance with the IMO speed depend- proven primary method. The type of homogeni-
ent NOx limit, measured according to ISO 8178 zer is either ultrasonic or mechanical, using wa-
Test Cycles E2/E3 for Heavy Duty Diesel Engines. ter from the freshwater generator and the water
mist catcher. The pressure of the homogenised
fuel has to be increased to prevent the formation
NOx Reduction Methods of steam and cavitation. It may be necessary to
modify some of the engine components such as
The NOx content in the exhaust gas can be re- the fuel oil pressure booster, fuel injection valves
duced with primary and/or secondary reduction and the engine control system.
methods.
The primary methods affect the combustion pro- Up to 9598% NOx Reduction
cess directly by reducing the maximum combus-
tion temperature, whereas the secondary me- When operating at full load, this reduction can be
thods are means of reducing the emission level achieved by means of secondary methods, such
without changing the engine performance, using as the SCR (Selective Catalytic Reduction), which
external equipment. involves an aftertreatment of the exhaust gas,
see Section 3.02. At lower load a 80-90% NOx re-
duction can be obtained, measured according to
030% NOx Reduction the ISO 8178 E2/E3 Test Cycles.
The MC and MC-C engines are as standard deliv- Plants designed according to this method have
ered to comply with IMO NOx emission limitations, been in service since 1990 on five vessels, using
EoD 4 06 060. Engine test cycles E2 and E3 has Haldor Topsøe catalysts and ammonia as the re-
to be ordered as an option, 4 06 060a and 060b, ducing agent, urea can also be used.
and various conditions can be specified, options
4 06 060f, 060g and 060h. Compliance with other The compact SCR unit can be located separately
emission limits can be specified as an option, 4 in the engine room or horizontally on top of the
06 065. engine. The compact SCR reactor is mounted
before the turbocharger(s) in order to have the
Regardless of the emission limit specified, the en- optimum working temperature for the catalyst.
gines are matched for best economy in service. However attention have to be given to the type of
HFO to be used.
For further information on engine operation op-
tions, see Extent of Delivery. For further information about emission control,
please refer to our publication:
3
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 3.01
Page of 1
Turbocharger Choice
The MC/ME engines are designed for the applica- The data specified in the printed edition are valid
tion of either MAN Diesel, ABB or Mitsubishi (MHI) at the time of publishing.
turbochargers.
However, for the latest up to date data, we recom-
The turbocharger choice is made with a view to mend the ‘Turbocharger selection’ programme on
obtaining the lowest possible Specific Fuel Oil the Internet, which can be used to identify a list
Consumption (SFOC) values at the nominal MCR of applicable turbochargers for a specific engine
by applying high efficiency turbochargers. layout.
The engines are, as standard, equipped with as The programme will always be updated in con-
few turbochargers as possible, see the table in nection with the latest information from the
Fig. 3.01.01. Turbocharger makers. This is available at:
www.mandiesel.com, under ‘Turbocharger’ →
One more turbocharger can be applied, than the ‘Overview’ → ‘Turbocharger selection’.
number stated in the tables, if this is desirable
due to space requirements, or for other reasons. For information about turbocharger arrangement
Additional costs are to be expected. and cleaning systems, see Section 15.01.
High efficiency turbochargers for the MAN B&W L60MC-C8, L60ME-C8 engines L1 output
Cyl. MAN (TCA) ABB (TPL) MHI (MET)
5 1 x TCA77-20 1 x TPL77-B12/CL 1 x MET66MA
6 1 x TCA77-20 1 x TPL80-B12/CL 1 x MET71MA
7 1 x TCA88-20 1 x TPL85-B14 1 x MET83MA
8 1 x TCA88-20 1 x TPL85-B15 1 x MET83MA
9 1 x TCA88-20 1 x TPL85-B15 1 x MET83MA
Conventional turbochargers for the MAN B&W L60MC-C8, L60ME-C8 engines L1 output
Cyl. MAN (TCA) ABB (TPL) MHI (MET)
5 1 x TCA66-20 1 x TPL77-B12 1 x MET60MA
6 1 x TCA77-20 1 x TPL80-B12 1 x MET66MA
7 1 x TCA77-20 1 x TPL80-B12/CL 1 x MET71MA
8 1 x TCA88-20 1 x TPL85-B14 1 x MET83MA
9 1 x TCA88-20 1 x TPL85-B15 1 x MET83MA
By-pass flange
Exhaust receiver
Centre of cylinder
Turbocharger
178 06 721.1
Air
Process
computer
Evaporator Ammonia
tank
SCR reactor
Air intake
Air outlet
Exhaust gas outlet
Deck
Support
Static mixer
Air
Orifice
High efficiency turbocharger
Engine
198 99 271.0
Electricity Production
4
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 4.01
Page of 6
Electricity Production
Introduction
æ æ æ æ æ 4OTAL
!LTERNATIVE¬TYPES¬AND¬LAYOUTS¬OF¬SHAFT¬GENERATORS¬ $ESIGN¬ 3EATING¬ ¬EFFICIENCY¬
æ æ æ "7æ)'#2æ /NæENGINEæ
æ æ æ æ VERTICALæGENERATOR
æ æ æ "7æ))'#2æ /NæTANKæTOPæ
04/'#2
æ æ æ "7æ)))'#2æ /NæENGINEæ
178 19 663.1
Designation of PTO
For further information, please refer to our publi-
cation titled:
178 06 490.0
50: 50 Hz
60: 60 Hz
kW on generator terminals
Mark version
178 39 556.0
PTO/RCF
Side mounted generator, BWIII/RCF is bolted directly to the frame box of the main
(Fig. 4.01.01, Alternative 3) engine. The bearings of the three gear wheels
are mounted in the gear box so that the weight of
The PTO/RCF generator systems have been de- the wheels is not carried by the crankshaft. In the
veloped in close cooperation with the German frame box, between the crankcase and the gear
gear manufacturer RENK. A complete package drive, space is available for tuning wheel, counter-
solution is offered, comprising a flexible coupling, weights, axial vibration damper, etc.
a stepup gear, an epicyclic, variableratio gear
with builtin clutch, hydraulic pump and motor, The first gear wheel is connected to the crank-
and a standard generator, see Fig. 4.01.03. shaft via a special flexible coupling made in one
piece with a tooth coupling driving the crankshaft
For marine engines with controllable pitch pro- gear, thus isolating it against torsional and axial
pellers running at constant engine speed, the vibrations.
hydraulic system can be dispensed with, i.e. a
PTO/GCR design is normally used. By means of a simple arrangement, the shaft in
the crankshaft gear carrying the first gear wheel
Fig. 4.01.03 shows the principles of the PTO/RCF and the female part of the toothed coupling can
arrangement. As can be seen, a stepup gear box be moved forward, thus disconnecting the two
(called crankshaft gear) with three gear wheels parts of the toothed coupling.
/PERATINGæPANEL
INæSWITCHBOARD
3ERVOæVALVE
(YDROSTATICæMOTOR
4OOTHED
COUPLING 'ENERATOR
2#&#ONTROLLER
(YDROSTATICæPUMP
!NNULUSæRING
-ULTIDISCæCLUTCH 3UNæWHEEL
0LANETARYæGEARæWHEEL
4OOTHEDæCOUPLING
#RANKSHAFT
%LASTICæDAMPINGæCOUPLING
#RANKSHAFTæGEAR
4OOTHEDæCOUPLING
178 23 222.1
Fig. 4.01.03: Power take off with RENK constant frequency gear: BW III/RCF, option: 4 85 253
The power from the crankshaft gear is trans- Extent of delivery for BWIII/RCF units
ferred, via a multidisc clutch, to an epicyclic
variableratio gear and the generator. These are The delivery comprises a complete unit ready to
mounted on a common bedplate, bolted to brack- be builton to the main engine. Fig. 4.02.01 shows
ets integrated with the engine bedplate. the required space and the standard electrical
output range on the generator terminals.
The BWIII/RCF unit is an epicyclic gear with a
hydrostatic superposition drive. The hydrostatic Standard sizes of the crankshaft gears and the
input drives the annulus of the epicyclic gear in RCF units are designed for:
either direction of rotation, hence continuously 700, 1200, 1800 and 2600 kW, while the generator
varying the gearing ratio to keep the genera- sizes of make A. van Kaick are:
tor speed constant throughout an engine speed
variation of 30%. In the standard layout, this is 440 V 60 Hz 380 V 50 Hz
between 100% and 70% of the engine speed at Type
1800 r/min 1500 r/min
DSG
specified MCR, but it can be placed in a lower kVA kW kVA kW
range if required. 62 M24 707 566 627 501
62 L14 855 684 761 609
The input power to the gear is divided into two
62 L24 1,056 845 940 752
paths – one mechanical and the other hydrostatic
74 M14 1,271 1,017 1,137 909
– and the epicyclic differential combines the
power of the two paths and transmits the com- 74 M24 1,432 1,146 1,280 1,024
bined power to the output shaft, connected to the 74 L14 1,651 1,321 1,468 1,174
generator. The gear is equipped with a hydrostatic 74 L24 1,924 1,539 1,709 1,368
motor driven by a pump, and controlled by an 86 K14 1,942 1,554 1,844 1,475
electronic control unit. This keeps the generator 86 M14 2,345 1,876 2,148 1,718
speed constant during single running as well as 86 L24 2,792 2,234 2,542 2,033
when running in parallel with other generators. 99 K14 3,222 2,578 2,989 2,391
178 34 893.1
The multidisc clutch, integrated into the gear in-
put shaft, permits the engaging and disengaging In the event that a larger generator is required,
of the epicyclic gear, and thus the generator, from please contact MAN Diesel.
the main engine during operation.
If a main engine speed other than the nominal is
An electronic control system with a RENK control- required as a basis for the PTO operation, it must
ler ensures that the control signals to the main be taken into consideration when determining the
electrical switchboard are identical to those for ratio of the crankshaft gear. However, it has no
the normal auxiliary generator sets. This applies influence on the space required for the gears and
to ships with automatic synchronising and load the generator.
sharing, as well as to ships with manual switch-
board operation. The PTO can be operated as a motor (PTI) as well
as a generator by making some minor modifica-
Internal control circuits and interlocking functions tions.
between the epicyclic gear and the electronic
control box provide automatic control of the func-
tions necessary for the reliable operation and
protection of the BWIII/RCF unit. If any monitored
value exceeds the normal operation limits, a warn-
ing or an alarm is given depending upon the ori-
gin, severity and the extent of deviation from the
permissible values. The cause of a warning or an
alarm is shown on a digital display.
1. Cooling water pipes to the builton lubricating The capacities stated in the ‘List of capacities’ for
oil cooling system, including the valves. the main engine in question are to be increased
by the additional capacities for the crankshaft
2. Electrical power supply to the lubricating oil gear and the RCF gear stated in Fig. 4.03.02.
standby pump built on to the RCF unit.
$ ( ' 3
!
&
"
178 36 29-6.1
kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 2,647 2,647 2,787 2,787
B 632 632 632 632
C 3,307 3,307 3,587 3,587
D 3,699 3,699 3,979 3,979
F 1,682 1,802 1,922 2,032
G 2,391 2,391 2,751 2,751
H 2,067 2,569 2,954 4,284
S 390 480 570 620
System mass (kg) with generator:
22,750 26,500 38,100 51,050
System mass (kg) without generator:
20,750 23,850 33,800 45,850
The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR
Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.
Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min
Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll L60C/RCF
4OOTHEDæCOUPLING
!LTERNATOR
"EDFRAME
2#&GEAR
IFæORDERED
#RANKSHAFTæGEAR
Fig. 4.03.01a: Engine preparations for PTO 178 57 15-7.0
Pos.
1 Special face on bedplate and frame box
2 Ribs and brackets for supporting the face and machined blocks for alignment of gear or stator housing
3 Machined washers placed on frame box part of face to ensure that it is flush with the face on the bedplate
4 Rubber gasket placed on frame box part of face
5 Shim placed on frame box part of face to ensure that it is flush with the face of the bedplate
6 Distance tubes and long bolts
7 Threaded hole size, number and size of spring pins and bolts to be made in agreement with PTO maker
8 Flange of crankshaft, normally the standard execution can be used
9 Studs and nuts for crankshaft flange
10 Free flange end at lubricating oil inlet pipe (incl. blank flange)
11 Oil outlet flange welded to bedplate (incl. blank flange)
12 Face for brackets
13 Brackets
14 Studs for mounting the brackets
15 Studs, nuts and shims for mounting of RCF/generator unit on the brackets
16 Shims, studs and nuts for connection between crankshaft gear and RCF/generator unit
17 Engine cover with connecting bolts to bedplate/frame box to be used for shop test without PTO
18 Intermediate shaft between crankshaft and PTO
19 Oil sealing for intermediate shaft
20 Engine cover with hole for intermediate shaft and connecting bolts to bedplate/frame box
21 Plug box for electronic measuring instrument for checking condition of axial vibration damper
22 Tacho encoder for ME control system or Alpha lubrication system on MC engine
23 Tacho trigger ring for ME control system or Alpha lubrication system on MC engine
Pos. no: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
BWIII/RCF A A A A B A B A A A A A B B A A A
BWIII/CFE A A A A B A B A A A A A B B A A A
BWII/RCF A A A A A A A
BWII/CFE A A A A A A A
BWI/RCF A A A A B A B A A A
BWI/CFE A A A A B A B A A A A A
DMG/CFE A A A B C A B A A A
A: Preparations to be carried out by engine builder
B: Parts supplied by PTOmaker
C: See text of pos. no.
178 89 342.0
Crankshaft gear lubricated from the main engine lubricating oil system
The figures are to be added to the main engine capacity list:
Nominal output of generator kW 700 1,200 1,800 2,600
Lubricating oil flow m /h
3
4.1 4.1 4.9 6.2
Heat dissipation kW 12.1 20.8 31.1 45.0
Deck
Filling pipe
The dimensions
of dosage tank
depend on actual
type of gear Engine
oil
To main engine
Main
engine DR
DS
S S The letters refer to the ‘List of flanges’,
C/D C/D which will be extended by the engine builder,
when PTO systems are built on the main engine
From purifier
To purifier
Lube oil
bottom tank
178 25 235.0
DMG/CFE Generators
Option: 4 85 259
Fig. 4.01.01 alternative 5, shows the DMG/CFE For generators in the normal output range, the
(Direct Mounted Generator/Constant Frequency mass of the rotor can normally be carried by the
Electrical) which is a low speed generator with foremost main bearing without exceeding the per-
its rotor mounted directly on the crankshaft and missible bearing load (see Fig. 4.03.05), but this
its stator bolted on to the frame box as shown in must be checked by the engine manufacturer in
Figs. 4.03.04 and 4.03.05. each case.
The DMG/CFE is separated from the crankcase If the permissible load on the foremost main bear-
by a plate and a labyrinth stuffing box. ing is exceeded, e.g. because a tuning wheel
is needed, this does not preclude the use of a
The DMG/CFE system has been developed in co- DMG/CFE.
operation with the German generator manufactur-
ers Siemens and AEG, but similar types of gene-
rator can be supplied by others, e.g. Fuji, Taiyo
and Nishishiba in Japan.
Cubicles:
Distributor
Synchronous To switchboard
condenser Converter
Excitation
Control
Cooler
Stator housing
178 06 733.1
Crankshaft Crankshaft
Support
bearing
Pole wheel
Pole wheel
Tuning wheel
178 06 637.1
Fig. 4.03.05: Standard engine, with direct mounted generator and tuning wheel
Synchronous
condenser
Excitation converter
DMG
Smoothing reactor
Diesel engine Static converter
178 56 553.1
SMG/CFE Generators
Static converter
The PTO SMG/CFE (see Fig. 4.01.01 alternative 6)
The static frequency converter system (see Fig. has the same working principle as the PTO DMG/
4.03.06) consists of a static part, i.e. thyristors and CFE, but instead of being located on the front end
control equipment, and a rotary electric machine. of the engine, the alternator is installed aft of the
engine, with the rotor integrated on the intermedi-
The DMG produces a threephase alternating ate shaft.
current with a low frequency, which varies in ac-
cordance with the main engine speed. This alter- In addition to the yard deliveries mentioned for the
nating current is rectified and led to a thyristor in- PTO DMG/CFE, the shipyard must also provide
verter producing a threephase alternating current the foundation for the stator housing in the case
with constant frequency. of the PTO SMG/CFE.
Since the frequency converter system uses a DC The engine needs no preparation for the installa-
intermediate link, no reactive power can be sup- tion of this PTO system.
plied to the electric mains. To supply this reactive
power, a synchronous condenser is used. The
synchronous condenser consists of an ordinary
synchronous generator coupled to the electric
mains.
Power Take Off/Gear Constant Ratio Power Take Off/Gear Constant Ratio
The PTO system type BWII/GCR illustrated in Fig. The shaft generator system, type PTO BW IV/
4.01.01 alternative 5 can generate electrical power GCR, installed in the shaft line (Fig. 4.01.01 al-
on board ships equipped with a controllable pitch ternative 6) can generate power on board ships
propeller, running at constant speed. equipped with a controllable pitch propeller run-
ning at constant speed.
The PTO unit is mounted on the tank top at the
fore end of the engine see Fig. 4.04.01. The PTO The PTO system can be delivered as a tunnel gear
generator is activated at sea, taking over the elec- with hollow flexible coupling or, alternatively, as
trical power production on board when the main a generator stepup gear with thrust bearing and
engine speed has stabilised at a level correspond- flexible coupling integrated in the shaft line.
ing to the generator frequency required on board.
The main engine needs no special preparation for
The installation length in front of the engine, and mounting these types of PTO systems as they are
thus the engine room length requirement, natu- connected to the intermediate shaft.
rally exceeds the length of the engine aft end
mounted shaft generator arrangements. However, The PTO system installed in the shaft line can also
there is some scope for limiting the space require- be installed on ships equipped with a fixed pitch
ment, depending on the configuration chosen. propeller or controllable pitch propeller running in
Step-up gear
Generator
Elastic coupling
178 18 225.0
combinator mode. This will, however, require an Generator stepup gear and flexible coupling
additional RENK Constant Frequency gear (Fig. integrated in the shaft line
4.01.01 alternative 2) or additional electrical equip-
ment for maintaining the constant frequency of For higher power take off loads, a generator
the generated electric power. stepup gear and flexible coupling integrated in
the shaft line may be chosen due to first costs of
gear and coupling.
Tunnel gear with hollow flexible coupling
The flexible coupling integrated in the shaft line
This PTO system is normally installed on ships will transfer the total engine load for both propul-
with a minor electrical power take off load com- sion and electrical power and must be dimen-
pared to the propulsion power, up to approxi- sioned accordingly.
mately 25% of the engine power.
The flexible coupling cannot transfer the thrust
The hollow flexible coupling is only to be dimensioned from the propeller and it is, therefore, necessary
for the maximum electrical load of the power take off to make the gearbox with an integrated thrust
system and this gives an economic advantage for minor bearing.
power take off loads compared to the system with an
ordinary flexible coupling integrated in the shaft line. This type of PTO system is typically installed on
ships with large electrical power consumption,
The hollow flexible coupling consists of flexible e.g. shuttle tankers.
segments and connecting pieces, which allow
replacement of the coupling segments without
dismounting the shaft line, see Fig. 4.04.02.
Auxiliary Propulsion System/Take Home System To obtain high propeller efficiency in the auxiliary
propulsion mode, and thus also to minimise the
From time to time an Auxiliary Propulsion System/ auxiliary power required, a twospeed tunnel gear,
Take Home System capable of driving the CP pro- which provides lower propeller speed in the auxil-
peller by using the shaft generator as an electric iary propulsion mode, is used.
motor is requested.
The twospeed tunnel gear box is made with a
MAN Diesel can offer a solution where the friction clutch which allows the propeller to be
CP propeller is driven by the alternator via a clutched in at full alternator/motor speed where
twospeed tunnel gear box. The electric power is the full torque is available. The alternator/motor is
produced by a number of GenSets. The main en- started in the declutched condition with a start
gine is disengaged by a clutch (RENK KAZ) made transformer.
as an integral part of the shafting. The clutch is in-
stalled between the tunnel gear box and the main The system can quickly establish auxiliary propul-
engine, and conical bolts are used to connect and sion from the engine control room and/or bridge,
disconnect the main engine and the shafting. even with unmanned engine room.
See Figure 4.04.03.
Reestablishment of normal operation requires
A thrust bearing, which transfers the auxiliary pro- attendance in the engine room and can be done
pulsion propeller thrust to the engine thrust bear- within a few minutes.
ing when the clutch is disengaged, is built into the
RENK KAZ clutch. When the clutch is engaged,
the thrust is transferred statically to the engine
thrust bearing through the thrust bearing built into
the clutch.
-AINæENGINE
4WOçSPEEDæTUNNELæGEARBOX
'ENERATORMOTOR
2ENKæ+!:æCLUTCH
/ILæDISTRIBUTIONæRING
(YDRAULICæCOUPLING
)NTERMEDIATEæBEARING
&LEXIBLEæCOUPLING
178 57 16-9.0
A B 830 000
C Q
178 23 031.0
**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (1,000 r/min) 2,751 1,400 4,151 2,226 9.5
5 (1,200 r/min) 2,751 1,400 4,151 2,226 9.5
6 (1,000 r/min) 3,026 1,490 4,516 2,226 10.5
6 (1,200 r/min) 3,026 1,490 4,516 2,226 10.5
7 (1,000 r/min) 3,301 1,585 4,886 2,226 11.4
7 (1,200 r/min) 3,301 1,585 4,886 2,266 11.4
8 (1,000 r/min) 3,576 1,680 5,256 2,266 12.4
8 (1,200 r/min) 3,576 1,680 5,256 2,266 12.4
9 (1,000 r/min) 3,851 1,680 5,531 2,266 13.1
9 (1,200 r/min) 3,851 1,680 5,531 2,266 13.1
P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm
Q Min. distance between engines: 1,800 mm
* Depending on alternator
** Weight incl. standard alternator (based on a Leroy Somer alternator)
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.
178 33 874.3
Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
Max. continuous rating at 1,000 rpm kW 450 540 630 720 810
Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
Max continues rating 1,200 rpm kW 500 660 770 880 990
The stated heat balances are based on tropical conditions.The exhaust gas data (exhaust gas flow, exhaust gas temp.
and air consumption). are based on ISO ambient condition.
* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80°C, and 44°C for the LT water
Example: If the inlet temperature is 25°C then the LT flow will change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow.
If the temperature rises above 36°C, then the L.T. outlet will rise acordingly.
# 1
178 23 043.2
**Dry weight
Cyl. no A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (900 rpm) 3,959 1,820 5,680 3,180 21.5
5 (1000 rpm) 3,959 1,870 5,730 3,180 21.5
6 (900 rpm) 4,314 1,870 6,086 3,180 23.7
6 (1000 rpm) 4,314 2,000 6,216 3,180 23.7
7 (900 rpm) 4,669 1,970 6,760 3,180 25.9
7 (1000 rpm) 4,669 1,970 6,537 3,180 25.9
8 (900 rpm) 5,024 2,250 7,210 3,287 28.5
8 (1000 rpm) 5,024 2,250 7,176 3,287 28.5
9 (900 rpm) 5,379 2,400 7,660 3,287 30.9
9 (1000 rpm) 5,379 2,400 7,660 3,287 30.9
P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2000 mm.
Q Min. distance between engines: 2400 mm (without gallery) and 2600 mm (with galley)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight incl. standard alternator (based on a Uljanik alternator)
All dimensions and masses are approximate, and subject to changes without prior notice.
Engine-driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m³/h 55 55 55 55 55
HT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m³/h 55 55 55 55 55
Lubricating oil pump (3-5 bar) m³/h 31 31 41 41 41
External pumps:
Max. delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.65 0.91 1.06 1.21 1.36
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m³/h 0.32 0.44 0.52 0.59 0.67
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.66 0.92 1.07 1.23 1.38
Cooling capacities:
Lubricating oil kW 195 158 189 218 247
LT charge air kW 118 313 366 418 468
Total LT system kW 313 471 555 636 715
LT flow at 36°C inlet and 44°C outlet* m³/h 27.0 44.0 48.1 51.9 54.0
Jacket cooling kW 154 274 326 376 427
HT charge air kW 201 337 383 429 475
Total HT system kW 355 611 709 805 902
HT flow at 44°C inlet and 80°C outlet* m³/h 8.5 19.8 22.6 25.3 27.9
Total from engine kW 668 1082 1264 1441 1617
LT flow from engine at 36°C inlet m³/h 27.0 43.5 47.6 51.3 53.5
LT outlet temperature from engine at 36°C inlet °C 55 58 59 61 63
( 1-string cooling water system )
Gas data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 6,679 9,600 11,200 12,800 14,400
Exhaust gas temperature at turbine outlet °C 335 348 348 348 348
Maximum allowable back pressure bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 6,489 9,330 10,900 12,400 14,000
Starting air system:
Air consumption per start incl. air for jet assist Nm³ 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8
Heat radiation:
Engine kW 49 50 54 58
Alternator kW ( See separate data from alternator maker )
The stated heat balances are based on 100% load and tropical
condition.
The mass flows and exhaust gas temperature are based on ISO
ambient condition.
* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80°C, and
44°C for the LT water.
At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.
17856 53-3.0
Example: If the inlet temperature is 25°C then the LT flow will
change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow.
The HT flow will not change.
Engine-driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m³/h 61 61 61 61 61
HT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m³/h 61 61 61 61 61
Lubricating oil pump (3-5 bar) m³/h 34 34 46 46 46
External pumps:
Max. delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.69 0.92 1.08 1.23 1.38
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m³/h 0.34 0.45 0.53 0.60 0.68
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.70 0.93 1.09 1.25 1.40
Cooling capacities:
Lubricating oil kW 206 162 192 222 252
LT charge air kW 125 333 388 443 499
Total LT system kW 331 495 580 665 751
LT flow at 36°C inlet and 44°C outlet* m³/h 35.5 47.8 52.1 56.2 60.5
Jacket cooling kW 163 280 332 383 435
HT charge air kW 212 361 411 460 509
Total HT system kW 374 641 743 843 944
HT flow at 44°C inlet and 80°C outlet* m³/h 8.9 20.9 23.9 26.7 29.5
Total from engine kW 705 1136 1323 1508 1695
LT flow from engine at 36°C inlet m³/h 35.5 47.2 51.5 55.6 59.9
LT outlet temperature from engine at 36°C inlet °C 53 57 59 60 61
(1-string cooling water system)
Gas data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 6,920 10,200 11,900 13,600 15,300
Exhaust gas temperature at turbine outlet °C 335 333 333 333 333
Maximum allowable back pressure bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 6,720 9,940 11,600 13,200 14,900
Starting air system:
Air consumption per start incl. air for jet assist Nm³ 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8
Heat radiation:
Engine kW 21 47 50 54 56
Alternator kW ( See separate data from alternator maker )
The stated heat balances are based on 100% load and tropical
condition.
The mass flows and exhaust gas temperature are based on ISO
ambient condition.
* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80°C, and
44°C for the LT water.
At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.
17856 53-3.0
Example: If the inlet temperature is 25°C then the LT flow will
change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow.
The HT flow will not change.
H P
A B ,270 ,600
C Q
178 23 067.0
**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (720 r/min) 3,369 2,155 5,524 2,383 18.0
5 (750 r/min) 3,369 2,155 5,524 2,383 18.0
6 (720 r/min) 3,738 2,265 6,004 2,383 19.7
6 (750 r/min) 3,738 2,265 6,004 2,383 19.7
6 (900 r/min) 3,738 2,265 6,004 2,815 21.0
7 (720 r/min) 4,109 2,395 6,504 2,815 21.4
7 (750 r/min) 4,109 2,395 6,504 2,815 21.4
7 (900 r/min) 4,109 2,395 6,504 2,815 22.8
8 (720 r/min) 4,475 2,480 6,959 2,815 23.5
8 (750 r/min) 4,475 2,480 6,959 2,815 23.5
8 (900 r/min) 4,475 2,340 6,815 2,815 24.5
P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm 178 34 537.1
Q Min. distance between engines: 2,250 mm
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes a standard alternator, make A. van Kaick
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.
Max. continuous rating at 720/750 RPM kW 525/550 650/675 780/810 910/945 1,040/1,080
Engine-driven Pumps:
Fuel oil feed pump (5.5-7.5 bar) m3/h 1. 0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
L.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 55 55 55 55 55
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 36 36 36 36 36
Lub. oil main pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 16 16 16 20 20
Separate Pumps:
Diesel oil pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.36/0.38 0.46/0.48 0.55/0.57 0.64/0.67 0.73/0.76
Fuel oil supply pump *** (4 bar discharge pressure) m3/h 0.18/0.19 0.22/0.23 0.27/0.28 0.31/0.33 0.36/0.37
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.37/0.39 0.46/0.48 0.56/0.58 0.65/0.67 0.74/0.77
L.T. cooling water pump* (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 35 35 42 48 55
L.T. cooling water pump** (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 48 48 54 60 73
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 20 20 24 28 32
Lub. oil stand-by pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 14.0 14.0 15.0 16.0 17.0
Cooling Capacities:
Lubricating Oil:
Heat dissipation kW 63 69 84 98 112
L.T. cooling water quantity* m3/h 4.6 5.3 6.4 7.5 8.5
L.T. cooling water quantity** m3/h 18 18 18 18 25
Lub. oil temp. inlet cooler °C 67 67 67 67 67
L.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler °C 36 36 36 36 36
Charge Air:
Heat dissipation kW 156 251 299 348 395
L.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 30 30 36 42 48
L.T. cooling water inlet cooler °C 36 36 36 36 36
Jacket Cooling:
Heat dissipation kW 154 182 219 257 294
H.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 20 20 24 28 32
H.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler °C 77 77 77 77 77
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 4,310 5,510 6,620 7,720 8,820
Exhaust gas temp. °C 310 310 310 310 310
Max. allowable back. press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/s 1.17 1.49 1.79 2.09 2.39
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 19 21 25 29 34
Generator kW (See separate data from generator maker)
The stated heat dissipation, capacities of gas and engine-driven pumps are given at 720 RPM. Heat dissipation gas and pump capaci-
ties at 750 RPM are 4% higher than stated. If L.T. cooling are sea water, the L.T. inlet is 32° C instead of 36°C.
Based on tropical conditions, except for exhaust flow and air consumption which are based on ISO conditions.
* Only valid for engines equipped with internal basic cooling water system nos. 1 and 2.
** Only valid for engines equipped with combined coolers, internal basic cooling water system no. 3.
*** To compensate for built on pumps, ambient condition, calorific value and adequate circulations flow. The ISO fuel oil consumption is
multiplied by 1.45.
Fig. 4.08.02a: List of capacities for L23/30H, 720/750 rpm
Engine-driven Pumps:
Fuel oil feed pump (5.5-7.5 bar) m3/h 1.3 1.3 1.3
L.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 69 69 69
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 45 45
Lub. oil main pump (3.5-5 bar) m3/h 20 20 20
Separate Pumps:
Diesel oil pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.69 0.81 0.92
Fuel oil supply pump*** (4 bar discharge pressure) m3/h 0.34 0.40 0.45
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.70 0.82 0.94
L.T. cooling water pump* (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 52 61 70
L.T. cooling water pump** (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 63 71 85
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 30 35 40
Lub. oil stand-by pump (3.5-5 bar) m3/h 17 18 19
Cooling Capacities:
Lubricating Oil:
Heat dissipation kW 117 137 158
L.T. cooling water quantity* m3/h 7.5 8.8 10.1
SW L.T. cooling water quantity** m3/h 18 18 25
Lub. oil temp. inlet cooler °C 67 67 67
L.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler °C 36 36 36
Charge Air:
Heat dissipation kW 369 428 487
L.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 46 53 61
L.T. cooling water inlet cooler °C 36 36 36
Jacket Cooling:
Heat dissipation kW 239 281 323
H.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 30 35 40
H.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler °C 77 77 77
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 8,370 9,770 11,160
Exhaust gas temp. °C 325 325 325
Max. allowable back. press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/s 2.25 2.62 3.00
Startiang Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2.0 2.0 2.0
Haeat Radiation:
Engine kW 32 37 42
Generator kW (See separat data from generator maker)
If L.T. cooling are sea water, the L.T. inlet is 32° C instead of 36° C.
Based on tropical conditions, except for exhaust flow and air consumption which are based on ISO conditions.
* Only valid for engines equipped with internal basic cooling water system nos. 1 and 2.
** Only valid for engines equipped with combined coolers, internal basic cooling water system no. 3.
*** To compensate for built on pumps, ambient condition, calorific value and adequate circulations flow. The ISO fuel oil consumption is
multiplied by 1.45.
H P
A B ,480 ,770
C Q ,285
178 23 079.0
**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (720 r/min) 4,346 2,486 6,832 3,705 42.3
5 (750 r/min) 4,346 2,486 6,832 3,705 42.3
6 (720 r/min) 4,791 2,766 7,557 3,705 45.8
6 (750 r/min) 4,791 2,766 7,557 3,717 46.1
7 (720 r/min) 5,236 2,766 8,002 3,717 52.1
7 (750 r/min) 5,236 2,766 8,002 3,717 52.1
8 (720 r/min) 5,681 2,986 8,667 3,717 56.3
8 (750 r/min) 5,681 2,986 8,667 3,717 58.3
9 (720 r/min) 6,126 2,986 9,112 3,797 63.9
9 (750 r/min) 6,126 2,986 9,112 3,797 63.9
P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm 178 33 898.2
Q Min. distance between engines: 2,900 mm (without gallery) and 3,100 mm (with gallery)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes a standard alternator
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.
Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
Max continues rating 720 RPM kW 1,500 1,980 2,310 2,640 2,970
Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
Max continues rating 750 RPM kW 1,600 1,980 2,310 2,640 2,970
Engine driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump 2.5 bar m³/h 70 70 70 70 70
HT cooling water pump 2.5 bar m³/h 70 70 70 70 70
Lubricating oil main pump 8 bar m³/h 66 66 96 96 96
Separate pumps:
Max. Delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 1.10 1.34 1.57 1.79 2.01
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m³/h 0.54 0.66 0.77 0.88 0.99
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 1.11 1.36 1.59 1.81 2.04
Cooling capacity:
Lubricating oil kW 217 283 328 376 420
Charge air LT kW 155 392 436 473 504
Total LT system kW 372 675 764 849 924
Flow LT at 36°C inlet and 44°C outlet m³/h 40 70 70 70 70
Jacket cooling kW 402 486 573 664 754
Charge air HT kW 457 558 640 722 802
Total HT system kW 859 1,044 1,213 1,386 1,556
Flow HT at 44°Cinlet and 80°C outlet m³/h 21 22 27 32 38
Total from engine kW 1,231 1,719 1,977 2,235 2,480
LT flow at 36°C inlet m³/h 40 70 70 70 70
LT temp. Outlet engine °C 62 55 58 61 64
(at 36°C and 1 string cooling water system)
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 11,693 15,000 17,400 19,900 22,400
Exhaust gas temp. °C 330 305 305 305 305
Max. Allowable back press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 11,662 14,600 17,000 19,400 21,800
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2.5 2.9 3.3 3.8 4.3
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 54 64 75 68 73
Alternator kW (see separate data from the alternator maker)
H P
A B ,490 ,800
C Q ,26
178 23 092.0
**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (720 r/min) 4,279 2,400 6,679 3,184 32.6
5 (750 r/min) 4,279 2,400 6,679 3,184 32.6
6 (720 r/min) 4,759 2,510 7,269 3,184 36.3
6 (750 r/min) 4,759 2,510 7,269 3,184 36.3
7 (720 r/min) 5,499 2,680 8,179 3,374 39.4
7 (750 r/min) 5,499 2,680 8,179 3,374 39.4
8 (720 r/min) 5,979 2,770 8,749 3,374 40.7
8 (750 r/min) 5,979 2,770 8,749 3,374 40.7
9 (720 r/min) 6,199 2,690 8,889 3,534 47.1
9 (750 r/min) 6,199 2,690 8,889 3,534 47.1
P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm
Q Min. distance between engines: 2,655 mm (without gallery) and 2,850 mm (with gallery)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes a standard alternator, make A. van Kaick
178 33 921.3
Engine-driven Pumps:
Fuel oil feed pump (5.5-7.5 bar) m3/h 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4
L.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 45 60 75 75 75
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 45 45 60 60 60
Lub. oil main pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 23 23 23 31 31 31
Separate Pumps:
Diesel oil Pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.60/0.64 0.73/0.77 0.88/0.92 1.02/1.08 1.17/1.23 1.32/1.38
Fuel oil supply pump *** (4 bar discharge pressure) m3/h 0.29/0.31 0.36/0.38 0.43/0.45 0.50/0.53 0.57/0.60 0.64/0.68
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m³/h 0.61/0.65 0.74/0.78 0.89/0.93 1.04/1.09 1.18/1.25 1.33/1.40
L.T. cooling water pump* (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 45 54 65 77 89
L.T. cooling water pump** (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 65 65 73 95 105 115
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 37 37 45 50 55 60
Lub. oil stand-by pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 22 22 23 25 27 28
Cooling Capacities:
Lubricating Oil:
Heat dissipation kW 91 105 127 149 172 194
L.T. cooling water quantity* m3/h 6.4 7.8 9.4 11.0 12.7 14.4
SW L.T. cooling water quantity** m3/h 28 28 28 40 40 40
Lub. oil temp. inlet cooler °C 67 67 67 67 67 67
L.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler °C 36 36 36 36 36 36
Charge Air:
Heat dissipation kW 305 393 467 541 614 687
L.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 37 37 45 55 65 75
L.T. cooling water inlet cooler °C 36 36 36 36 36 36
Jacket Cooling:
Heat dissipation kW 211 264 320 375 432 489
H.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 37 37 45 50 55 60
H.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler °C 77 77 77 77 77 77
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 7,710 9,260 11,110 12,970 14,820 16,670
Exhaust gas temp. °C 305 305 305 305 305 305
Max. allowable back. press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/s 2.09 2.51 3.02 3.52 4.02 4.53
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 22 26 32 38 44 50
Generator kW (See separat data from generator maker)
The stated heat dissipation, capacities of gas and engine-driven pumps are given at 720 RPM. Heat dissipation gas and pump capaci-
ties at 750 RPM are 4% higher than stated. If L.T. cooling are sea water, the L.T. inlet is 32° C instead of 36°C.
Based on tropical conditions, except for exhaust flow and air consumption which are based on ISO conditions.
* Only valid for engines equipped with internal basic cooling water system nos. 1 and 2.
** Only valid for engines equipped with combined coolers, internal basic cooling water system no. 3.
*** To compensate for built on pumps, ambient condition, calorific value and adequate circulations flow. The ISO fuel oil consumption
is multiplied by 1.45.
Installation Aspects
5
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 5.01
Page of 1
The space requirements stated in Section 5.02 Please note that the distance E in Fig. 5.02.01,
are valid for engines rated at nominal MCR (L1). given for a doublejib crane is from the centre
of the crankshaft to the lower edge of the deck
The additional space needed for engines beam.
equipped with PTO is stated in Chapter 4.
A special crane beam for dismantling the turbo-
If, during the project stage, the outer dimensions charger must be fitted. The lifting capacity of the
of the turbocharger seem to cause problems, it crane beam for dismantling the turbocharger is
is possible, for the same number of cylinders, to stated in Section 5.03.
use turbochargers with smaller dimensions by
increasing the indicated number of turbochargers The overhaul tools for the engine are designed
by one, see Chapter 3. to be used with a crane hook according to DIN
15400, June 1990, material class M and load ca-
pacity 1Am and dimensions of the single hook
Overhaul of Engine type according to DIN 15401, part 1.
The distances stated from the centre of the crank- The total length of the engine at the crankshaft
shaft to the crane hook are for the normal lifting level may vary depending on the equipment to
procedure and the reduced height lifting proce- be fitted on the fore end of the engine, such as
dure (involving tilting of main components). adjustable counterweights, tuning wheel, moment
The lifting capacity of a normal engine room crane compensators or PTO.
can be found in Fig. 5.04.01.
Please note that the latest version of the di-
The area covered by the engine room crane shall mensioned drawing is available for download
be wide enough to reach any heavy spare part re- at www.mandiesel.com under ‘Marine’ → ‘Low-
quired in the engine room. Speed’ → ‘MC Engine Programme’, choose en-
gine type and click ‘Download installation Draw-
A lower overhaul height is, however, available by ings for...’ the actual engine and turbocharger
using the MAN B&W DoubleJib crane, built by configuration. Select ‘Engine outline’ in the list of
Danish Crane Building A/S, shown in Figs. 5.04.02 drawings available for download.
and 5.04.03.
Space Requirement
' "
#YLæ
$ECKæBEAM
#
6ª
&
%
(
"ULKHEAD
&LOOR
*
4ANKæTOP
$
,UBæOILæTANK
#OFFERDAM
+ !
178 57 87-5.0
Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)
Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8 9
A min. 7,122 8,142 9,162 10,182 11,202 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 7,597 8,617 9,637 10,657 11,677 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
Mitsubishi
Units MET60 MET66 MET71 MET83
W kg 1,000 1,500 1,800 2,700
HB mm 1,600 1,800 1,800 2,200
b m 700 800 800 800
178 52 340.1 The figures ‘a’ are stated on the ‘Engine and Gallery Outline’
drawing, Section 5.06.
Fig. 5.03.01a: Required height and distance Fig. 5.03.01b: Required height and distance and weight
For the overhaul of a turbocharger, a crane beam The crane beams are to be placed in relation
with trolleys is required at each end of the turbo- to the turbocharger(s) so that the components
charger. around the gas outlet casing can be removed in
connection with overhaul of the turbocharger(s).
Two trolleys are to be available at the compressor
end and one trolley is needed at the gas inlet end. The crane beam can be bolted to brackets that
are fastened to the ship structure or to columns
Crane beam no. 1 is for dismantling of turbo- that are located on the top platform of the engine.
charger components.
Crane beam no. 2 is for transporting turbocharger The lifting capacity of the crane beam for the
components. heaviest component ‘W’, is indicated in Fig.
See Figs. 5.03.01a and 5.03.02. 5.03.01b for the various turbocharger makes. The
crane beam shall be dimensioned for lifting the
The crane beams can be omitted if the main en- weight ‘W’ with a deflection of some 5 mm only.
gine room crane also covers the turbocharger
area. HB indicates the position of the crane hook in the
vertical plane related to the centre of the turbo-
The crane beams are used and dimensioned for charger. HB and b also specifies the minimum
lifting the following components: space for dismantling.
• Exhaust gas inlet casing For engines with the turbocharger(s) located on
• Turbocharger inlet silencer the exhaust side, EoD No. 4 59 122, the letter
• Compressor casing ‘a’ indicates the distance between vertical cen-
• Turbine rotor with bearings trelines of the engine and the turbocharger.
#RANEæBEAMæFORæTRANSPORTATIONæOFæCOMPONENTS
#RANEæBEAMæFORæDISMANTLINGæOFæCOMPONENTS
3PARES
#RANEæBEAMæFORæDISMANTLINGæOFæCOMPONENTS
#RANEæBEAMæFORæTRANSPORTATIONæOFæCOMPONENTS
178 52 746.0
%NGINEæROOMæCRANE
æ
178 52 734.0
Overhaul/exchange of charge air cooler. 3. Take out the cooler insert by using the above
placed crane beam mounted on the engine.
The text and figure are for guidance only. 4. Turn the cooler insert to an upright position.
5. Dismantle the platforms below the air cooler.
Valid for air cooler design for the following en- 6. Lower down the cooler insert between the gal-
gines with more than one turbochargers mounted lery brackets and down to the engine room
on the exhaust side: floor.
• 60MCC/MEC Make sure that the cooler insert is supported,
• S65MEC e.g. on a wooden support.
• 70MCC/MEC 7. Move the air cooler insert to an area covered
• S80MCC/MEC by the engine room crane using the lifting
• 90MC/MCC/ME/MEC beam mounted below the lower gallery of the
• 98MC/MCC/ME/MEC engine.
8. By using the engine room crane the air cooler
1. Dismantle all the pipes in the area around the insert can be lifted out of the engine room.
air cooler.
2. Dismantle all the pipes around the inlet cover
for the cooler.
$
.ORMALæCRANE
$ECK $ECK
$ECKæBEAM $ECKæBEAM
""
#
!
!
#RANKSHAFT #RANKSHAFT
"ASEæLINEæ "ASEæLINEæ
1) The lifting tools for the engine are designed to fit together
2ECOMMENDEDæAREAæTOæBEæCOVEREDæ with a standard crane hook with a lifting capacity in ac-
BYæTHEæENGINEæROOMæCRANEæææ
cordance with the figure stated in the table. If a larger
crane hook is used, it may not fit directly to the overhaul
!
Normal crane
Height to crane hook in
MAN B&W DoubleJib Crane
mm for:
Crane capacity in
Crane
tons selected in ac- Reduced
Weight in kg including operating
cordance with DIN height lifting
lifting tools width in
and JIS standard ca- Normal procedure
mm Buildingin height
pacities lifting involving tilt-
ing of main in mm
procedure
components
(option)
Cylinder Cylinder Piston Normal MAN B&W A B1 B1 C D
cover liner with crane DoubleJib Minimum Minimum Minimum Minimum Additional height
complete with- piston Crane distance height from height from height from required for re-
with cooling rod and centreline centreline centreline moval of exhaust
exhaust jacket stuffing crankshaft crankshaft valve without
crankshaft
valve box to centreline to under- removing any
to underside
crane hook side deck exhaust valve
deck beam
beam stud
2,575 2,775 1,550 3.2 2x2.0 2,650 9,675 9,125 8,925 575
The crane hook travelling area must cover at least The crane hook should at least be able to reach
the full length of the engine and a width in accord- down to a level corresponding to the centreline of
ance with dimension A given on the drawing, see the crankshaft.
crosshatched area.
For overhaul of the turbocharger(s), trolley mount-
It is furthermore recommended that the engine ed chain hoists must be installed on a separate
room crane can be used for transport of heavy crane beam or, alternatively, in combination with
spare parts from the engine room hatch to the the engine room crane structure, see ‘Crane beam
spare part stores and to the engine. See example for overhaul of turbochargers’ with information
on this drawing. about the required lifting capacity for overhaul of
turbocharger(s).
178 24 863.0
$ECKæBEAM
-
#HAINæCOLLECTINGæBOX
178 37 30-1.0
Engine Outline
Gallery Outline
#YLæ
!FTæCYL
C
D
A
&ORE
3PACEæFORæOVERHAULING
ANDæMOUNTINGæOF
MOMENTæCOMPENSATOR B
G
MOMENTæCOMPENSATOR
2EGARDINGæPITCHæCIRCLEæDIAMETERæNUMBERæANDæSIZE
OFæBOLTSæFORæTHEæINTERMEDIATEæSHAFT
CONTACTæTHEæENGINEæBUILDER
#YLæ
!FTæCYL
&ORE
178 22 79-1.1
Please note that the latest version of the dimensioned drawing is available for download at www.mandiesel.com under ‘Marine’ →
‘Low Speed’ → ‘Installation Drawings’. First choose engine series, then engine type and select ‘Outline drawing’ for the actual num-
ber of cylinders and type of turbocharger installation in the list of drawings available for download.
!FTæCYL
#YLæ
C
D
A
C
&ORE
3PACEæFORæOVERHAULING B
ANDæMOUNTINGæOF
MOMENTæCOMPENSATOR
G
ææCYL ææCYLæææCYL
WITHOUTæMOMENTæ
2EGARDINGæPITCHæCIRCLEæDIAMETERæNUMBERæANDæSIZE COMPENSATOR
OFæBOLTSæFORæTHEæINTERMEDIATEæSHAFT
CONTACTæTHEæENGINEæBUILDER
Fig. 5.06.02a: Engine outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
#YLæ
!FTæCYL
&ORE
178 22 80-1.1
Please note that the latest version of the dimensioned drawing is available for download at www.mandiesel.com under ‘Marine’ →
‘Low Speed’ → ‘Installation Drawings’. First choose engine series, then engine type and select ‘Outline drawing’ for the actual num-
ber of cylinders and type of turbocharger installation in the list of drawings available for download.
Fig. 5.06.02b: Engine outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
!FTæCYL
#YLæ
G
C
C
&ORE
æ#YL
MAN TCA55-21 6 2,650 6,327 1,768 4,828 4,050 7,400 9,050 4,005 6 5,100
Diesel TCA66-21 7-8 2,900 6,327 1,828 5,908 4,210 8,420 10,070 4,158 7 6,120
TPL73 6 2,600 6,093 1,720 4,780 4,050 7,400 9,050 4,005 8 7,140
ABB
TPL77 7-8 2,700 6,209 1,823 5,903 4,210 8,420 10,070 4,158
MET53MA 6-8 Available on request
MHI
MET60MA 6-8 Available on request
176 78 84-7.3.0
Fig. 5.06.01a: Gallery outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
#YLæ
!FTæCYL
D
B
&ORE
çæCYLæ æ#YL
WITHOUTæMOMENTæ
COMPENSATOR
176 78 84-7.3.0
Fig. 5.06.01b: Gallery outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
500%2æ0,!4&/2-æçææCYL
æææ&LOORæPLATEææMM æHOLESæFORæPISTONæOVERHAULING
9 Xª
9
Xª
D
D
500%2æ0,!4&/2-æçææCYL
&LOORæPLATEææMM æHOLESæFORæPISTONæOVERHAULING 4ç4
9 Xª
9
Xª
D
176 78 84-7.3.0
Fig. 5.06.01c: Gallery outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
500%2æ0,!4&/2-æçææCYL
AULING æHOLESæFORæPISTONæOVERHAULING
æææ&LOORæPLATEææMM
Xª
Xª 9
9
Xª
D
F
ERHAULING 4ç4 9ç9
Xª
Xª
3TANCHIONæANDæHANDRAIL
176 78 84-7.3.0
F
Fig. 5.06.01c: Gallery outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
æ,/7%2æ0,!4&/2-æçææCYLæ
&LOORæPLATEææMM
Xª
Xª
4
4
F
!IR !IR
COOLER COOLER
,/7%2æ0,!4&/2-æ
&LOORæPLATEææMM
çæCYLæWITHOUTæMOMENTæCOMPENSATOR
Xª
Xª
4
F
!IR !IR
COOLER COOLER
176 78 84-7.3.0
Please note that the latest version of the dimensioned drawing is available for download at www.mandiesel.com under ‘Marine’ →
‘Low Speed’ → ‘Installation Drawings’. First choose engine series, then engine type and select ‘Outline drawing’ for the actual num-
ber of cylinders and type of turbocharger installation in the list of drawings available for download.
Fig. 5.06.01c: Gallery outline, 6-8L60MC-C with two turbochargers on exhaust side
Centre of Gravity
#ENTREæOFæGRAVITY
#ENTREæOFæCRANSHAFT
#ENTREæOFæCYLINDERæ
178 56 66-5.0
For 6-8 cylinder engines with two turbochargers and 5 cylinder engines with one turbucharger
No. of cylinders 5 6 7 8 9
Distance X mm 2,510 3,020 3,485 3,940 4,400
Distance Y mm 2,365 2,500 2,500 2,520 2,525
Distance Z mm 130 205 190 185 185
All values stated are approximate
!&4æ#9,
#9,æ
C
S
ç&/2%ç
$ %æ%
!2
!.
+æ,æ!( !0 !5
!!
æ+æ, ! Z !#
N
0
æ!(
. F
25
!+
!" &OREæEND
Y
!% J !% !%
!6
!3 æ&
!, !-
æ"8æ"&
V &
K
L
3 3 3
Q
P
R
ææ#YLææææ#YL
æ#YL 7ITHOUTæMOMENT
COMPENSATORæ 176 93 56-3.1.0
1 1
1 1
1
1 1 1 1
1 1 1
Fig. 5.09.01a: Engine pipe connections, 5-8L60MC-C with turbocharger on exhaust side
Eæ$ æææææ
Hæ%
æææææ
Aæææææ
ææ8
- -
!FTæEND &
æ!4 %æ%
æ!$
æ!&
æ"$ Næææææ
!4 !$ !& Dææææææ "8æ"&
"$ $
Bææææ
+ !( ! !.
æ!
!5 Uæ!.
æ,æ+æ!( æ
!2 æ!5
, !0 Tæ!0 ç&/2%ç
# !!
Hæ!!
!# æ!#
"
æ0 "6
0 æ. æ
æ25
"6 . "6
25
Xæææææ
&OREæEND !+
Xæ!" !"
!6
æ!+ !,æ!- æ!,æ!-
!' æ!6 !% !%
æ& æ!%
!%
æ"8æ"& 8 !% æ!3
& "& !3
"8
3
æ!%
æ!6
Wæ!,æ!-
ææ!3
Sæ!!
Iææ!-
Mæ!0
æ0.
ææ#YLææææ#YL
7ITHOUTæMOMENT ææ#YLææææ#YL æ
COMPENSATORæ 7ITHOUTæMOMENT
COMPENSATORæ
176 93 56-3.1.0
1 1
Cyl. No. g p q r
1
1 1
1 1 1
1 1 1
Fig. 5.09.01b: Engine pipe connections, 5-8L60MC-C with turbocharger on exhaust side
æ!4æ!&
æ"$
æ!$
!&4æ#9,
#9,æ
Eæ$ æææææ
Hæ%
Aæææææ
!$
ææ8
- - #
&
%æ% "$
!&æ!4
Næææææ "8æ"&
Dææææææ
$
Bææææ
+ !( ! !.
æ!
Uæ!.
æ,æ+æ!( æ
æ!5
, !0 Tæ!0 ç&/2%ç
!! "
Hæ!!
!# æ!#
æ0 "6
0 æ. æ
æ25
. "6
Xæææææ
!+ !"
"
!6
!+ !,æ!- æ!,æ!- !' !%
æ!6 !% !%
% æ!%
æ!3 !'
!3
æ!%
æ!6
Wæ!,æ!-
ææ!3
Sæ!!
Iææ!-
Mæ!0
æ0.
1 1
→
→
Fig. 5.09.01c: Engine pipe connections, 5-8L60MC-C with turbocharger on exhaust side
Counterflanges
The list of flanges will be extended, when a PTO system is built onto the engine
Cylinder lubrication
Table 5.10.01a: List of counterflanges, L60MC-C7/8, 5-8S60MC-C7/8, option: 4 30 202. Reference is made to section
5.09 Engine Pipe Connections
Connection E
-!.æ4#! -!.æ4#! -!.æ4#! æ-%4
Xæ0#$
Counterflanges, Connection D
$IAæ
,
!
0#
$
Aæ
)7
$I
&
"
7
$
),
'
#
% .æXæDIAMETERæ/ .æXæDIAMETERæ/
X
$
"
),
' X
# .Xæ4HREADæ
$IAæ
,
!
0#
$ Aæ
)7
$I
7
"
$
&
),
'
# .æXæDIAMETERæ/ .æXæDIAMETERæ/
TPL77 1,372 638 1,176 462 1,294 390 1,170 580 130 130 28 ø26
7
$
"
&
0#
MAN B&W $ Aæ 5.10
)7
$I
7
"
$
&
), Page of 3
,
!
)7
7
$
"
&
),
'
# .æXæDIAMETERæ/
Type MET
T.C. L W IL IW A B C D F G N O
MET33MA Available on request
MET42MA 883 365 793 275 850 240 630 335 80 90 24 ø15
MET53MA 1,122 465 1,006 349 1,073 300 945 420 100 105 28 ø20
MET60MA 1,230 660 1,120 388 1,190 315 1,050 500 105 105 30 ø20
MET66MA 1,380 560 1,254 434 1,330 345 1,200 510 115 120 30 ø24
MET71MA 1,520 700 1,400 480 1,475 345 1,265 640 115 115 34 ø20
MET83MA 1,740 700 1,586 550 1,680 450 1,500 640 150 150 30 ø24
MET90MA 1,910 755 1,750 595 1,850 480 1,650 695 160 165 30 ø24
503 26 38-6.0.0
æMMæTHICK
æMMæFREEæSPACESæFORæSUPPORTINGæWEDGES DAMMINGS
" !
" !
¢
ææ%NGINE
ææ!FTææ#YL
ææ4HURST
BEARING
ææ#YL
ææ#YL
ææ#YL
ææ#YL
¢
4HEæWIDTHæOFæMACHININGæON
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
¢
THEæUNDERSIDEæOFæBEDPLATE
æHOLESæINæTHEæBEDPLATEæANDææHOLESæINæTHEæTOPPLATE
-XæHOLESæPREDRILLEDææINæTHEæBEDPLATEæANDææHOLESæINæTHEæTOPPLATE
XæOFFææHOLES
%NDæFLANGEæOFæTHRUSTæSHAFT
!ç!
%FFECTIVEæ æTOæææENGINE
%POXYæWEDGESæTOæBE
CHISELLEDæAFTER !LIGNMENT "ç"
CURINGæTOæENABLE SCREW
MOUNTINGæOFæSIDE
CHOCKæLINERS
0LUG
178 23 50-8.1
For details of chocks and bolts see special drawings. 1) The engine builder drills the holes for holding
down bolts in the bedplate while observing the
For securing of supporting chocks see special toleranced locations indicated on MAN B&W
drawing. drawings for machining the bedplate
This drawing may, subject to the written consent of 2) The shipyard drills the holes for holding down
the actual engine builder concerned, be used as a bolts in the top plates while observing the toler-
basis for markingoff and drilling the holes for hold- anced locations given on the present drawing
ing down bolts in the top plates, provided that:
3) The holding down bolts are made in accord-
ance with MAN B&W drawings of these bolts.
4HISæSPACEæTOæBEæKEPTæFREEæFROMæPIPESæETCæALONGæBOTHæSIDES
OFæTHEæENGINEæINæORDERæTOæFACILITATEæTHEæOVERHAULæWORKæON
HOLDINGæDOWNæBOLTSæSUPPORTINGæCHOCKSæANDæSIDEæCHOCKS
#ENTRELINEæENGINE
$
"
æææ
æç
)FæREQUIREDæBY
CLASSIFICATION
SOCIETYæAPPLY
THISæBRACKET
4HICKNESSæOF
BRACKETæISæTHE
SAMEæASæTHICKNESS
OFæFLOORPLATES
" 2
3LOTSæTOæBEæCUTæINæVERTICALæFLOORPLATESæTOæCLEARæNUTSæWHENæNECESSARY
4HICKNESSæOFæFLOORPLATESæBETWEENæMAINæENGINEæGIRDERSææMM
3ECTION¬"
"
Side chock brackets, option: 4 82 622 includes:
1. Side chock brackets
#ENTRELINEæ
CYLINDER $ETAIL¬$
!
!
178 57 36-1.0
End chock bolts, option: 4 82 610 includes:
4APERææ
ABOUTæ 1. Stud for end chock bolt
2. Round nut
3. Round nut
4. Spherical washer
ABOUTæ
5. Spherical washer
6. Protecting cap
178 57 22-8.0
Fig. 5.12.02c: Profile of engine seating, end chocks, option: 4 82 610
The mechanical top bracing is to be made by the By a different pre-setting of the relief valve, the
shipyard in accordance with MAN Diesel instruc- top bracing is delivered in a low-pressure version
tions. (26 bar) or a high-pressure version (40 bar).
!
The top bracing unit is designed to allow dis-
! placements between the hull and engine caused
by thermal expansion of the engine or different
loading conditions of the vessel.
!!
/ILæ!CCUMULATOR
(YDRAULICæ#ONTROLæ5NIT
178 23 61-6.1
#YLINDERæ5NIT
Hydraulic top bracing
æ0
1
-INæ2
4# 4#
#
A A B F G H I
4#
#
A A B F G H I
#ENTREæLINE
CYLINDERæ 4# 4#
#
#YL
4HISæSYMBOLæINDICATESæ 4HISæSYMBOLæINDICATESæ
THATæTHEæTOPæBRACINGæISæ THATæTHEæTOPæBRACINGæISæ
ATTACHEDæATæPOINTæ0 ATTACHEDæATæPOINTæ1
4URBOCHARGER
4#
#
#YLINDERæNUMBER #HAINæBOX
AA D E
# 4#
AA D E F
# 4#
AA B E F G
# 4#
AA B F G H
#ENTREæLINE
CRANKSHAFT
# 4#
-INæ
AA B F G H I
# 4#
#ENTREæLINEæCYLINDER
#ENTREæLINE
CYLINDERæ 4HISæSYMBOLæINDICATESæ
AæTOPæBRACING
# 4#
!LTERNATIVEæ !LTERNATIVEæ
AA D E
#ENTREæLINEæCYLINDER
4# 4#
# #
AA E F
AA E F
4# 4# 4# 4#
# #
AA F G
AA E F
#ENTREæLINE
CRANKSHAFT 4# 4#
# #
'ALLERYæENDæ
'ALLERYæEND
æMM
'ALLERYæENDæ
'ALLERYæEND
æMM
AA F G
æ0LEASEæREFERæTOæTHE
æææ@%NGINEæANDæ'ALLERYæ/UTLINE AA F G
æææINæTHISæSECTION 4# 4# 4# 4#
# #
#ENTREæLINEæCYLINDERæ
AA G H
AA F G
4# 4#
# #
AA G H
AA G H
4# 4# 4# 4#
# #
AA H I
AA G H
4# 4# 4# 4#
# #
#ENTREæLINEæCYLINDER
AA H I
4HISæSYMBOLæINDICATESæTHATæTHEæTOPæ
BRACINGæISæATTACHEDæATæTHISæPOINT 4URBOCHARGER
4#
#YLINDERæNUMBER # #HAINæBOX
Force per bracing....................................... ± 81 kN Horizontal distance between top bracing fix point
Maximum horizontal deflection at the and cylinder 1:
link’s points of attachment to the hull
for four cylinders...................................... 0.33 mm a = 510 f = 5,610 i = 8,670
for two cylinders....................................... 0.23 mm d = 3,570 g = 6,630
e = 4,590 h = 7,650
178 23 56-9.1
AA D E
#ENTREæLINEæCYLINDER
# 4# # 4#
AA E F
AA D E
# 4# # 4#
AA F G
AA E F
# 4# # 4#
#ENTREæLINE
CRANKSHAFT
AA G H
AA F G
'ALLERYæENDææMM
'ALLERYæENDæ
'ALLERYæENDæ
'ALLERYæENDæMM
æ0LEASEæREFERæTOæTHE # 4# # 4#
æææ@%NGINEæANDæ'ALLERYæ/UTLINE
æææINæTHISæSECTION
AA H I
AA G H
# 4# # 4#
#ENTREæLINEæCYLINDER
AA H I
#ENTREæLINE
#YLINDERæ
4OPæBRACING 4URBOCHARGER
# 4#
#YLINDERæNUMBER #HAINæBOX
#ABLE
CONNECTED
TOæTHEæHULL
"RUSHæHOLDER
ARRANGEMENT
-ONITORING
EQUIPMENT
WITHæM6çMETER #ABLE
CONNECTED
TOæTHEæHULL
3LIPæRING #ABLE
TOæALARM
SYSTEM
3LIPæRING
FORæMONITORING
EQUIPMENT "RUSHæHOLDER
ARRANGEMENT
079 21 82-1.2.1.0
Fig. 5.17.01
A cable with a cross section not less than 45 mm² When the shaftline earthing device is working
is used for cabling the shaftline earthing device to correctly, the electrical potential will normally be
the hull. The length of the cable to the hull should within the range of 10-50 mV DC. The alarm set-
be as short as possible. points should be 5 mV for a low alarm and 80 mV
for a high alarm. The alarm signals with an alarm
Monitoring equipment should have a 4-20 mA delay of 30 seconds and an alarm cut-off, when
signal for alarm and a two range mV-meter with the engine is stopped, must be connected to the
a switch for changing range. Primary range from alarm system.
0 mV to 50 -150 mV DC, and secondary range
from 0 mV to 300-1500 mV DC. Connection of cables as shown on the sketch,
Fig. 5.17.01.
2UDDER
6OLTAGEæMONITORINGæ
FORæSHAFTçHULLæPOTENTIALæ
0ROPELLER DIFFERENCE
3HAFTLINE
EARTHINGæDEVICE
#URRENT -AINæBEARINGS
0ROPELLERæSHAFT 4HRUSTæBEARING
)NTERMEDIATEæSHAFT )NTERMEDIATEæSHAFTæBEARING
079 21 82-1.2.2.0
Fig. 5.17.02: The shaftline earthing device slip rings must be fitted on the foremost intermediate shaft as close to the
engine as possible
2UDDER
6OLTAGEæMONITORINGæ
FORæSHAFTçHULLæPOTENTIALæ
0ROPELLER DIFFERENCE
3HAFTLINE
EARTHINGæDEVICE
#URRENT -AINæBEARINGS
0ROPELLERæSHAFT 4HRUSTæBEARING
)NTERMEDIATEæSHAFT 3HAFTæMOUNTEDæALTERNATORæ
WHEREæTHEæROTORæISæPARTæOFæ
THEæINTERMEDIATEæSHAFT
)NTERMEDIATEæSHAFTæBEARING
079 21 82-1.2.3.0
Fig. 5.17.03: When a generator is fitted, the shaftline earthing device must be placed between the generator and the
engine
0ROPELLERæ$IAMETERæMM
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"3
6"
3
6"
3
%NGINEæ0OWERæ;æK7=
178 22 239.0
Identification:_ _______________________________
S W I
178 22 360.0
Type of vessel:_______________________________
For propeller design purposes please provide us
with the following information:
6. Classification Society:___________
Ice class notation:_ _____________
Main Dimensions
Table 5.18.03: Data sheet for propeller design purposes, in case model test is not available this table should be filled in
Propeller Clearance
Dismant-
High skew Nonskew Baseline
ling
Hub propeller propeller clearance
of cap
Y mm Y mm Z mm
X mm
VBS 1280 390
VBS 1380 420 1520% 2025% Min.
VBS 1460 450 of D of D 50100
VBS 1560 480
178 48 589.0
(YDRAULICæ0OWERæ5NIT
/ILæTANK
FORWARD
SEAL
3TERN
TUBEæOIL 0ITCH
TANK ORDER
0)
0!,
4)
0) 0!( 0!,
4!(
3ERVO
PISTON
0ITCH
FEEDBACK
(YDRAULIC
,IPæRINGæSEALS PIPE
- -
0ROPELLERæSHAFT
178 22 384.1
178 22 396.0
The servo oil tank unit, the Hydraulic Power Unit Maximum system pressure is set on the safety
Fig. 5.18.06, consists of an oil tank with all other valve.
components top mounted, to facilitate installation
at yard. The return oil is led back to the tank via a thermo-
static valve, cooler and paper filter.
Two electrically driven pumps draw oil from the oil
tank through a suction filter and deliver high pres- The servo oil unit is equipped with alarms accord-
sure oil to the proportional valve. ing to the Classification Society as well as neces-
sary pressure and temperature indicators.
One of two pumps are in service during normal
operation, while the second will start up at power- If the servo oil unit cannot be located with maxi-
ful manoeuvring. mum oil level below the oil distribution ring, the
system must incorporate an extra, small drain
A servo oil pressure adjusting valve ensures mini- tank complete with pump, located at a suitable
mum servo oil pressure at any time hereby mini- level, below the oil distributor ring drain lines.
mizing the electrical power consumption.
-AINæ#ONTROLæ3TATION
"RIDGEæ7ING #ENTER "RIDGEæ7ING
20- 0ITCH 20- 0ITCH 20- 0ITCH
$UPLICATEDæ.ETWORK
(ANDLES
"RIDGE INTERFACE
,OCALæENGINEæ %NGINEæOVERLOADæMAXæLOAD
CONTROL 3YSTEM
0ITCHæ3ET #OORDINATED
)NæGOVERNOR
34/0
34/0
2EMOTE,OCAL #ONTROL
34!24
0ROPELLERæ0ITCH
34/0
178 22 406.1
The Alphatronic 2000 remote control system is • Thrust control with optimization of propeller
designed for control of propulsion plants based pitch and shaft speed. Selection of combina-
on diesel engines with CP propellers. The plant tor, constant speed or separate thrust mode is
configuration could for instance include tunnel possible. The rates of changes are controlled to
gear with PTO/PTI, PTO gear, multiple engines on ensure smooth manoeuvres and avoidance of
one gearbox as well as multiple propeller plants. propeller cavitation.
As shown on fig. 5.18.07, the propulsion remote • A Load control function protects the engine
control system comprises a computer controlled against overload. The load control function con-
system with interconnections between control tains a scavenge air smoke limiter, a load pro-
stations via a redundant bus and a hard wired gramme for avoidance of high thermal stresses
backup control system for direct pitch control at in the engine, an automatic load reduction and
constant shaft speed. an engineer controlled limitation of maximum
load.
The computer controlled system contains func-
tions for: • Functions for transfer of responsibility be-
tween the local control stand, engine control
• Machinery control of engine start/stop, engine room and control locations on the bridge are
load limits and possible gear clutches. incorporated in the system.
æ
02/0%,,%2 02/0%,,%2
20- 0)4#(
"!#+æ50
). 4!+%
#/.42/,
#/.42/, #/.42/,
/./&&
178 22 418.1
For remote control, a minimum of one control sta- • Propeller monitoring panel with backup in-
tion located on the bridge is required. struments for propeller pitch and shaft speed.
This control station will incorporate three mod- • Thrust control panel with control lever for
ules, as shown on fig. 5.18.08: thrust control, an emergency stop button and
push buttons for transfer of control between
• Propulsion control panel with push buttons control stations on the bridge.
and indicators for machinery control and a dis-
play with information of condition of operation
and status of system parameter.
List of Capacities:
Pumps, Coolers &
Exhaust Gas
6
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 6.01
Page of 1
Nomenclature
In the following description and examples of the auxiliary machinery capacities, freshwater generator pro-
The List of Capacities contain data regarding the The capacities for the starting air receivers and
necessary capacities of the auxiliary machinery the compressors are stated in Fig. 6.03.01.
for the main engine only, and refer to a nominally
rated engine. Complying with IMO Tier I NOx limi-
tations. Heat radiation and air consumption
The heat dissipation figures include 10% extra The radiation and convection heat losses to the
margin for overload running except for the scav- engine room is around 1% of the engine nominal
enge air cooler, which is an integrated part of the power (kW in L1).
diesel engine.
The air consumption is approximately 98.2%
of the calculated exhaust gas amount, ie.
Cooling Water Systems Mair = Mexh x 0.982.
45 C
80 C
Seawater outlet
80 C
Jaket
water
Central cooler
cooler
Scavenge
air 43 C
cooler (s)
Lubricating
45 C oil
cooler
Central coolant
Seawater inlet 36 C
32 C
Fig. 6.02.02: Diagram for central cooling water system 178 11 276.1
1 x TPL77-B12/CL
1 x TPL77-B12/CL
1 x TPL77-B12
1 x TPL77-B12
1 x MET60MA
1 x MET66MA
1 x MET60MA
1 x MET66MA
1 x TCA66-20
1 x TCA77-20
1 x TCA66-20
1 x TCA77-20
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m³/h 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8 5.8
Fuel oil supply m³/h 3.0 3.0 3.0 2.9 2.9 2.9 3.0 3.0 3.0 2.9 2.9 2.9
Jacket cooling m³/h 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0 99.0
Seawater cooling * m³/h 355.0 360.0 355.0 375.0 375.0 370.0 355.0 355.0 355.0 365.0 365.0 365.0
Main lubrication oil * m³/h 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0 245.0
Central cooling * m³/h - - - - - - 285 285 280 295 295 295
Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW - - - - - - 7,200 7,210 7,180 7,440 7,430 7,420
Central water flow m³/h - - - - - - 285 285 280 295 295 295
Seawater flow m³/h - - - - - - 355 355 355 365 365 365
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0
Compressor cap. m³ 240 240 240 240 240 240 240 240 240 240 240 240
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5
Compressor cap. m³ 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
Other values
Fuel oil heater kW 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
Exh. gas temp. °C 265 265 265 245 245 245 265 265 265 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h 100,500 100,500 100,500 108,500 108,500 108,500 100,500 100,500 100,500 108,500 108,500 108,500
Air consumption kg/h 27.4 27.4 27.4 29.6 29.6 29.6 27.4 27.4 27.4 29.6 29.6 29.6
* For main engine arrangements with builton power takeoff (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system
For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/
Table 6.03.01e: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR
1 x TPL80-B12/CL
1 x TPL80-B12/CL
1 x TPL80-B12
1 x TPL80-B12
1 x MET66MA
1 x MET71MA
1 x MET66MA
1 x MET71MA
1 x TCA77-20
1 x TCA77-20
1 x TCA77-20
1 x TCA77-20
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m³/h 7.0 7.0 7.0 6.9 6.9 6.9 7.0 7.0 7.0 6.9 6.9 6.9
Fuel oil supply m³/h 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.5 3.5 3.5
Jacket cooling m³/h 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0 120.0
Seawater cooling * m³/h 430.0 430.0 425.0 445.0 445.0 445.0 425.0 425.0 425.0 440.0 440.0 440.0
Main lubrication oil * m³/h 295.0 295.0 290.0 295.0 295.0 295.0 295.0 295.0 290.0 295.0 295.0 295.0
Central cooling * m³/h - - - - - - 340 340 340 350 355 355
Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW - - - - - - 8,640 8,660 8,620 8,900 8,920 8,910
Central water flow m³/h - - - - - - 340 340 340 350 355 355
Seawater flow m³/h - - - - - - 425 425 425 440 440 440
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m³ 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5
Compressor cap. m³ 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
Other values
Fuel oil heater kW 185 185 185 180 180 180 185 185 185 180 180 180
Exh. gas temp. °C 265 265 265 245 245 245 265 265 265 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h 120,600 120,600 120,600 130,200 130,200 130,200 120,600 120,600 120,600 130,200 130,200 130,200
Air consumption kg/h 32.8 32.8 32.8 35.5 35.5 35.5 32.8 32.8 32.8 35.5 35.5 35.5
* For main engine arrangements with builton power takeoff (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system
For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/
Table 6.03.01f: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR
1 x TPL80-B12/CL
1 x TPL80-B12/CL
1 x TPL85-B14
1 x TPL85-B14
1 x MET71MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET71MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x TCA77-20
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA77-20
1 x TCA88-20
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m³/h 8.2 8.2 8.2 8.1 8.1 8.1 8.2 8.2 8.2 8.1 8.1 8.1
Fuel oil supply m³/h 4.2 4.2 4.2 4.1 4.1 4.1 4.2 4.2 4.2 4.1 4.1 4.1
Jacket cooling m³/h 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0 140.0
Seawater cooling * m³/h 500.0 500.0 500.0 520.0 520.0 520.0 495.0 495.0 495.0 510.0 510.0 510.0
Main lubrication oil * m³/h 340.0 340.0 340.0 345.0 345.0 345.0 340.0 340.0 340.0 345.0 345.0 345.0
Central cooling * m³/h - - - - - - 395 395 395 410 415 410
Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW - - - - - - 10,050 10,070 10,060 10,380 10,440 10,400
Central water flow m³/h - - - - - - 395 395 395 410 415 410
Seawater flow m³/h - - - - - - 495 495 495 510 510 510
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m³ 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5
Compressor cap. m³ 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
Other values
Fuel oil heater kW 215 215 215 210 210 210 215 215 215 210 210 210
Exh. gas temp. °C 265 265 265 245 245 245 265 265 265 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h 140,700 140,700 140,700 151,900 151,900 151,900 140,700 140,700 140,700 151,900 151,900 151,900
Air consumption kg/h 38.3 38.3 38.3 41.4 41.4 41.4 38.3 38.3 38.3 41.4 41.4 41.4
* For main engine arrangements with builton power takeoff (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system
For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/
Table 6.03.01g: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR
1 x TPL85-B14
1 x TPL85-B15
1 x TPL85-B14
1 x TPL85-B15
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA88-20
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m³/h 9.3 9.3 9.3 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.3 9.3 9.3 9.2 9.2 9.2
Fuel oil supply m³/h 4.8 4.8 4.8 4.7 4.7 4.7 4.8 4.8 4.8 4.7 4.7 4.7
Jacket cooling m³/h 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0 160.0
Seawater cooling * m³/h 570.0 570.0 570.0 590.0 600.0 600.0 570.0 570.0 570.0 580.0 590.0 580.0
Main lubrication oil * m³/h 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0 390.0
Central cooling * m³/h - - - - - - 450 455 455 470 470 470
Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW - - - - - - 11,500 11,550 11,520 11,850 11,900 11,870
Central water flow m³/h - - - - - - 450 455 455 470 470 470
Seawater flow m³/h - - - - - - 570 570 570 580 590 580
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m³ 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5
Compressor cap. m³ 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
Other values
Fuel oil heater kW 245 245 245 240 240 240 245 245 245 240 240 240
Exh. gas temp. °C 265 265 265 245 245 245 265 265 265 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h 160,800 160,800 160,800 173,600 173,600 173,600 160,800 160,800 160,800 173,600 173,600 173,600
Air consumption kg/h 43.8 43.8 43.8 47.3 47.3 47.3 43.8 43.8 43.8 47.3 47.3 47.3
* For main engine arrangements with builton power takeoff (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system
For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/
Table 6.03.01h: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR
1 x TPL85-B15
1 x TPL85-B15
1 x TPL85-B15
1 x TPL85-B15
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x MET83MA
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA88-20
1 x TCA88-20
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m³/h 10.5 10.5 10.5 10.4 10.4 10.4 10.5 10.5 10.5 10.4 10.4 10.4
Fuel oil supply m³/h 5.4 5.4 5.4 5.3 5.3 5.3 5.4 5.4 5.4 5.3 5.3 5.3
Jacket cooling m³/h 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0 180.0
Seawater cooling * m³/h 640.0 640.0 640.0 670.0 670.0 670.0 640.0 640.0 640.0 660.0 660.0 660.0
Main lubrication oil * m³/h 435.0 440.0 440.0 435.0 440.0 440.0 435.0 440.0 440.0 435.0 440.0 440.0
Central cooling * m³/h - - - - - - 510 510 510 530 530 530
Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW - - - - - - 12,910 12,960 12,930 13,310 13,360 13,330
Central water flow m³/h - - - - - - 510 510 510 530 530 530
Seawater flow m³/h - - - - - - 640 640 640 660 660 660
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m³ 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270 270
Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m³ 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5 2 x 2.5
Compressor cap. m³ 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 150
Other values
Fuel oil heater kW 275 275 275 275 275 275 275 275 275 275 275 275
Exh. gas temp. °C 265 265 265 245 245 245 265 265 265 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h 180,900 180,900 180,900 195,300 195,300 195,300 180,900 180,900 180,900 195,300 195,300 195,300
Air consumption kg/h 49.2 49.2 49.2 53.2 53.2 53.2 49.2 49.2 49.2 53.2 53.2 53.2
* For main engine arrangements with builton power takeoff (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system
For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/
Table 6.03.01i: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR
,
Cooler heat dissipations
, -
For the specified MCR (M) the following three dia- 1JW
grams in Figs. 6.04.01, 6.04.02 and 6.04.03 show /
,
reduction factors for the corresponding heat dis-
sipations for the coolers, relative to the values
stated in the ‘List of Capacities’ valid for nominal ,
MCR (L1).
3PECIFIEDæ-#2æPOWERææOFæ, N-
0- 3PECIFIEDæ-#2æENGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,
æ
The derated cooler capacities may then be found order to avoid too low a water velocity in the scav-
by means of following equations: enge air cooler pipes.
Qair, M = Qair, L1 x (Qair% / 100)
As the jacket water cooler is connected in series
Qjw, M = Qjw, L1 x (Qjw% / 100)
with the lube oil cooler, the seawater flow capac-
Qlub, M = Qlub, L1 x (Qlub% / 100) ity for the latter is used also for the jacket water
and for a central cooling water system the central cooler.
cooler heat dissipation is:
Qcent,M = Qair,M + Qjw,M + Qlub,M
Central cooling water system
The jacket cooling water pump capacity is rela- Irrespective of the capacities selected as per the
tively low. Practically no saving is possible, and it above guidelines, the belowmentioned pump
is therefore unchanged. heads at the mentioned maximum working tem-
peratures for each system shall be kept:
The derated seawater pump capacity is equal to Fuel oil supply pump 4 100
the sum of the below found derated seawater flow Fuel oil circulating pump 6 150
capacities through the scavenge air and lube oil Lubricating oil pump 4.1 70
coolers, as these are connected in parallel. Seawater pump 2.5 50
Central c ooling water pump 2.5 80
The seawater flow capacity for each of the scav-
Jacket water pump 3.0 100
enge air, lube oil and jacket water coolers can
be reduced proportionally to the reduced heat
dissipations found in Figs. 6.04.01, 6.04.02 and Flow velocities
6.04.03, respectively i.e. as follows:
Vsw,air,M = Vsw,air,L1 x (Qair% / 100) For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
following maximum velocities:
Vsw,lub,M = Vsw,lub.L1 x Qlub% / 100)
Vsw,jw,M = Vsw,lub,M Marine diesel oil .......................................... 1.0 m/s
Heavy fuel oil . ............................................. 0.6 m/s
However, regarding the scavenge air cooler(s), Lubricating oil ............................................. 1.8 m/s
the engine maker has to approve this reduction in Cooling water .............................................. 3.0 m/s
Pump and cooler capacities for a derated 6L60MC-C8 with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger
type TCA, fixed pitch propeller and central cooling water system.
Nominal MCR, (L1) PL1: 14,040 kW (100.0%) and 123.0 r/min (100.0%)
Specified MCR, (M) PM: 11,934 kW (85.0%) and 110.7 r/min (90.0%)
Optimising point, (O) PO: 10,741 kW (76.5%) and 106.9 r/min (86.9%), PO = 90.0% of PM
The method of calculating the reduced capaci- Total cooling water flow through scavenge air
ties for point M (nM% = 90.0% and PM% = 85.0%) is coolers
shown below. Vcw,air,M = Vcw,air,L1 x Qair% / 100
The values valid for the nominal rated engine are Vcw,air,M = 198 x 0.853 = 169 m3/h
found in the ‘List of Capacities’, Figs. 6.03.01 and
6.03.02, and are listed together with the result in Cooling water flow through lubricating oil cooler
the figure on the next page. Vcw,lub,M = Vcw,lub,L1x Qlub% / 100
Heat dissipation of scavenge air cooler Vcw,lub,M = 152 x 0.917 = 139 m3/h
Fig. 6.04.01 which approximately indicates a Qair%
= 83.1% heat dissipation, and corrected for opti- Cooling water flow through central cooler
mising point O lower than M, by applying correct- (Central cooling water pump)
ing factor kO, equal 83.1 x (1 + 0.27 x (1-0.900)) = Vcw,cent,M = Vcw,air,M + Vcw,lub,M
85.3%, i.e.:
Qair,M =Qair,L1 x Qair% / 100 Vcw,cent,M = 169 + 139 = 308 m3/h
Qair,M = 5,960 x 0.853 = 5,084 kW Cooling water flow through jacket water cooler
(as for lube oil cooler)
Heat dissipation of jacket water cooler Vcw,jw,M = Vcw,lub,M
Fig. 6.04.02 indicates a Qjw% = 88.5% heat dissi-
pation; i.e.: Vcw,jw,M = 139 m3/h
Qjw,M = Qjw,L1 x Qjw% / 100
Seawater pump for central cooler
Qjw,M = 2,080 x 0.885 = 1,841 kW As the seawater pump capacity and the central
cooler heat dissipation for the nominal rated en-
Heat dissipation of lube oil cooler gine found in the ‘List of Capacities’ are 440 m3/h
Fig. 6.04.03 indicates a Qlub% = 91.7% heat dis- and 8,900 kW the derated seawater pump flow
sipation; i.e.: equals:
Qlub,M = Qlub, L1 x Qlub% / 100
Seawater pump:
Qlub,M = 1,130 x 0.917 = 1,036 kW Vsw,cent,M = Vsw,cent,L1 x Qcent,M / Qcent,L1
Heat dissipation of central water cooler = 440 x 7,961 / 8,900 = 394 m3/h
Qcent,M = Qair,M + Qjw,M + Qlub, M
The air consumption and exhaust gas figures are expected and refer to 100% specified MCR,
ISO ambient reference conditions and the exhaust gas back pressure 300 mm WC
The exhaust gas temperatures refer to after turbocharger
* Calculated in example 3, in this chapter
Example 1 – Capacities of derated 6L60MC-C8 with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger type TCA and
central cooling water system.
Freshwater Generator
If a freshwater generator is installed and is utilis- At part load operation, lower than optimising
ing the heat in the jacket water cooling system, power, the actual jacket water heat dissipation will
it should be noted that the actual available heat be reduced according to the curves for fixed pitch
in the jacket cooling water system is lower than propeller (FPP) or for constant speed, controllable
indicated by the heat dissipation figures valid for pitch propeller (CPP), respectively, in Fig. 6.04.04.
nominal MCR (L1) given in the List of Capacities.
This is because the latter figures are used for With reference to the above, the heat actually
dimensioning the jacket water cooler and hence available for a derated diesel engine may then be
incorporate a safety margin which can be needed found as follows:
when the engine is operating under conditions
such as, e.g. overload. Normally, this margin is 1. Engine power between optimising and speci-
10% at nominal MCR. fied power.
0ARTæLOADæCORRECTIONæFACTORæFORæJACKETæ
2. Engine power lower than optimising power.
COOLINGæWATERæHEATæDISSIPATION
KP
For powers lower than the optimising power,
the value Qjw,O found for point O by means of
the above equation [1] is to be multiplied by
the correction factor kp found in Fig. 6.04.04
and hence
#00
where
Qjw = jacket water heat dissipation
Qjw,L1= jacket water heat dissipation at nominal
MCR (L1)
Qjw% = percentage correction factor from
Fig. 6.04.02
Qjw,O = jacket water heat dissipation at optimising
power (O), found by means of equation [1]
%NGINEæLOADææOFæOPTIMISINGæPOWERæ/ kp = part load correction factor from Fig. 6.04.04
&00ææ&IXEDæPITCHæPROPELLER 0.9 = factor for safety margin of cooler, tropical
#00ææ#ONTROLLABLEæPITCHæPROPELLERæCONSTANTæSPEED ambient conditions
178 59 45-7.0
PS
FPP : kp = 0.742 x __
PO
+ 0.258 The heat dissipation is assumed to be more or less
independent of the ambient temperature conditions,
PS
CPP : kp = 0.822 x __
P
+ 0.178 yet the safety margin/ambient condition factor of
O
about 0.88 instead of 0.90 will be more accurate for
Fig. 6.04.04: Correction factor ‘kp’ for jacket cooling ambient conditions corresponding to ISO tempera-
water heat dissipation at part load, relative to heat dis- tures or lower. The heat dissipation tolerance from
sipation at optimising power 15% to 0% stated above is based on experience.
%XPANSIONæTANK
3EAWATER
)N /UT *ACKETæCOOLING
WATERæCIRCUIT
0RODUCEDæ
FRESHWATER
%VAPORATOR " +
!
"RINEæOUT
$EAERATINGæTANK
*ACKETæWATER *ACKETæWATERæPUMPS
COOLER
-AINæENGINE
#OOLINGæ
WATER
178 23 700.0
Fig. 6.04.05: Freshwater generators. Jacket cooling water heat recovery flow diagram
Jacket Cooling Water Temperature Control If necessary, all the actually available jacket cool-
ing water heat may be used provided that a special
When using a normal freshwater generator of the temperature control system ensures that the jacket
singleeffect vacuum evaporator type, the fresh- cooling water temperature at the outlet from the
water production may, for guidance, be estimated engine does not fall below a certain level. Such a
as 0.03 t/24h per 1 kW heat, i.e.: temperature control system may consist, e.g., of a
special bypass pipe installed in the jacket cooling
Mfw = 0.03 x Qjw t/24h 15%/0% [3] water system, see Fig. 6.04.05, or a special builtin
temperature control in the freshwater generator,
where e.g., an automatic start/stop function, or similar.
Mfw is the freshwater production in tons per 24 If such a special temperature control is not applied,
hours we recommend limiting the heat utilised to maxi-
mum 50% of the heat actually available at specified
and MCR, and only using the freshwater generator at
engine loads above 50%. Considering the cooler
Qjw is to be stated in kW margin of 10% and the minus tolerance of 15%,
this heat corresponds to 50 x(1.000.15)x0.9 = 38%
of the jacket water cooler capacity Qjw,M used for
dimensioning of the jacket water cooler.
Freshwater production from a derated 6L60MC-C8 with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger type
TCA and fixed pitch propeller.
Based on the engine ratings below, this example will show how to calculate the expected available jacket
cooling water heat removed from the diesel engine, together with the corresponding freshwater production
from a freshwater generator.
The calculation is made for the service rating (S) of the diesel engine being 80% of the specified MCR.
Nominal MCR, (L1) PL1: 14,040 kW (100.0%) and 123.0 r/min (100.0%)
Specified MCR, (M) PM: 11,934 kW (85.0%) and 110.7 r/min (90.0%)
Optimising point, (O) PO: 10,741 kW (76.5%) and 106.9 r/min (86.9%), PO = 90.0% of PM
Service rating, (S) PS: 9,547 kW and 102.8 r/min, PS = 80.0% of PM and PS = 88.9% of PO
The expected available jacket cooling water heat For the service point the corresponding expected
at service rating is found as follows: obtainable freshwater production from a freshwa-
ter generator of the single effect vacuum evapora-
Qjw,L1 = 2,080 kW from List of Capacities tor type is then found from equation [3]:
Qjw% = 81.5% using 76.5% power and 86.9%
speed for O in Fig. 6.04.02 Mfw = 0.03 x Qjw = 0.03 x 1,369 = 41.1 t/24h
15%/0%
By means of equation [1], and using factor 0.88 for
actual ambient condition the heat dissipation in
the optimising point (O) is found:
Qjw%
Qjw,O = Qjw,L1 x ___
100
x 0.88
= 2,080 x ___
81.5
100
x 0.88 = 1,492 kW
The exhaust gas data to be expected in practice b) The ambient conditions, and exhaust gas
depends, primarily, on the following three factors: backpressure:
a) The specified MCR point of the engine (point M): Tair : actual ambient air temperature, in °C
pbar : actual barometric pressure, in mbar
PM : power in kW at SMCR point TCW : actual scavenge air coolant temperature,
nM : speed in r/min at SMCR point in °C
∆pM : exhaust gas backpressure in mm WC at
and to a certain degree on the optimising point specified MCR
O with the percentage power PO% = % of SMCR
power: c) The continuous service rating of the engine
(point S), valid for fixed pitch propeller or control-
PO% = (PO/PM) x 100% lable pitch propeller (constant engine speed):
Calculation Method
To enable the project engineer to estimate the ac- The partial calculations based on the above influ-
tual exhaust gas data at an arbitrary service rating, encing factors have been summarised in equations
the following method of calculation may be used. [4] and [5].
where, according to ‘List of capacities’, i.e. referring to ISO ambient conditions and 300 mm WC
backpressure and specified/optimised in L1:
ML1: exhaust gas amount in kg/h at nominal MCR (L1)
TL1: exhaust gas temperature after turbocharger in °C at nominal MCR (L1)
Fig. 6.04.06: Summarising equations for exhaust gas amounts and temperatures
The partial calculations based on the influencing changes in specific exhaust gas amount and
factors are described in the following: temperature are found by using as input in dia-
grams the corresponding percentage values (of
a) Correction for choice of specified MCR point L1) for specified MCR power PM% and speed nM%:
PM% = PM/PL1 x 100%
When choosing a specified MCR point ‘M’ other nM% = nM/nL1 x 100%
than the nominal MCR point ‘L1’, the resulting
,
æ ,
æª#
æ ç
æ æ æ æ æ æ æ Næ-æ æ æ æ æ æ æ æ Næ-æ
3PECIFIEDæ-#2æENGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,æ 3PECIFIEDæ-#2æENGINEæSPEEDææOFæ,æ
Fig. 6.04.07: Change of specific exhaust gas amount, Fig. 6.04.08: Change of exhaust gas temperature, ∆TM
∆mM% in % of L1 value and independent of PO in point M, in °C after turbocharger relative to L1 value
and valid for PO = PM
∆mM% : change of specific exhaust gas amount, in b) Correction for actual ambient conditions and
% of specific gas amount at nominal MCR backpressure
(L1), see Fig. 6.04.07.
For ambient conditions other than ISO
∆TM : change in exhaust gas temperature after 3046-1:2002 (E) and ISO 15550:2002 (E), and
turbocharger relative to the L1 value, in °C, backpressure other than 300 mm WC at
see Fig. 6.04.08. (PO = PM) specified MCR point (M), the correction fac-
tors stated in the table in Fig. 6.04.09 may
∆TO : extra change in exhaust gas temperature be used as a guide, and the corresponding
when optimising point O lower than 100% M: relative change in the exhaust gas data may
PO% = (PO/PM) x 100%. be found from equations [7] and [8], shown in
Fig. 6.04.10.
∆TO = 0.3 x (100 PO%) [6]
Change of Change of
exhaust gas exhaust gas
Parameter Change temperature amount
Blower inlet temperature + 10° C + 16.0° C 4.1 %
Blower inlet pressure (barometric pressure) + 10 mbar 0.1° C + 0.3 %
Charge air coolant temperature (seawater temperature) + 10° C + 1.0° C + 1.9 %
Exhaust gas back pressure at the specified MCR point + 100 mm WC + 5.0° C 1.1 %
Fig. 6.04.09: Correction of exhaust gas data for ambient conditions and exhaust gas back pressure
∆Mamb% = 0.41 x (Tair 25) + 0.03 x (pbar 1000) + 0.19 x (TCW 25 ) 0.011 x (∆pM 300) % [7]
∆Tamb = 1.6 x (Tair 25) 0.01 x (pbar 1000) +0.1 x (TCW 25) + 0.05 x (∆pM 300) °C [8]
∆Tamb : change in exhaust gas temperature, in °C compared with temperatures at ISO conditions
Fig. 6.04.10: Exhaust gas correction formula for ambient conditions and exhaust gas back pressure
mS%
TS
%
16
20
14
15
12
10 10
8
5
6 M
0
4
-5
2
M -10
0
-2 -15
∆mS%= 37 x (PS/PM)3 83 x (PS/PM)2 + 31 x (PS/PM) + 15 ∆TS = 262 x (PS/PM)2 413 x (PS/PM) + 151
Fig. 6.04.11: Change of specific exhaust gas amount, Fig. 6.04.12: Change of exhaust gas temperature,
∆ms% in % at part load, and valid for FPP and CPP ∆TS in °C at part load, and valid for FPP and CPP
Figs. 6.04.11 and 6.04.12 may be used, as ∆ms% : change in specific exhaust gas amount,
guidance, to determine the relative changes in % of specific amount at specified MCR
in the specific exhaust gas data when running point, see Fig. 6.04.11.
at part load, compared to the values in the
specified MCR point, i.e. using as input PS% = ∆Ts : change in exhaust gas temperature, in °C,
(PS/PM) x 100%: see Fig. 6.04.12.
Expected exhaust gas data for a derated 6L60MC-C8 with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger type
TCA and fixed pitch propeller.
Based on the engine ratings below, and by means of an example, this chapter will show how to calculate
the expected exhaust gas amount and temperature at service rating, and for a given ambient reference
condition different from ISO.
The calculation is made for the service rating (S) being 80%of the specified MCR power of the diesel engine.
Nominal MCR, (L1) PL1: 14,040 kW (100.0%) and 123.0 r/min (100.0%)
Specified MCR, (M) PM: 11,934 kW (85.0%) and 110.7 r/min (90.0%)
Optimising point, (O) PO: 10,741 kW (76.5%) and 106.9 r/min (86.9%), PO = 90.0% of PM
Reference conditions
Air temperature Tair ......................................... 20° C b) Correction for ambient conditions and
Scavenge air coolant temperature TCW .......... 18° C backpressure:
Barometric pressure pbar ........................ 1,013 mbar
Exhaust gas backpressure By means of equations [7] and [8]:
at specified MCR ∆pM ......................... 300 mm WC
∆Mamb% = 0.41 x (20 25) + 0.03 x (1,013 1,000)
a) Correction for choice of specified MCR point M + 0.19 x (18 25) 0.011 x (300 300) %
and optimising point O:
∆Mamb% = + 1.11%
11,934
PM% = _____
14,040 x 100 = 85.0%
∆Tamb = 1.6 x (20 25) 0.01 x (1,013 1,000)
nM% = ____
110.7
123.0
x 100 = 90.0% + 0.1 x (18 25) + 0.05 x (300 300) °C
∆Tamb = 8.8° C
By means of Figs. 6.04.07 and 6.04.08:
c) Correction for the engine load:
∆mM% = +0.25 %
∆TM = 7.2° C Service rating = 80% of specified MCR power
By means of Figs. 6.04.11 and 6.04.12:
As the engine is optimised in O lower than 100% M,
and PO% = 90.0% of PM ∆mS% = + 5.6%
Fuel
7
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 7.01
Page of 3
The system is so arranged that both diesel oil and The builton overflow valves, if any, at the supply
heavy fuel oil can be used, see figure 7.01.01. pumps are to be adjusted to 5 bar, whereas the
external bypass valve is adjusted to 4 bar. The
From the service tank the fuel is led to an electri- pipes between the tanks and the supply pumps
cally driven supply pump by means of which a shall have minimum 50% larger passage area
pressure of approximately 4 bar can be main- than the pipe between the supply pump and the
tained in the low pressure part of the fuel circulat- circulating pump.
ing system, thus avoiding gasification of the fuel
in the venting box in the temperature ranges ap- If the fuel oil pipe ‘X’ at inlet to engine is made as
plied. a straight line immediately at the end of the en-
gine, it will be necessary to mount an expansion
The venting box is connected to the service tank joint. If the connection is made as indicated, with
via an automatic deaerating valve, which will re- a bend immediately at the end of the engine, no
lease any gases present, but will retain liquids. expansion joint is required.
The fuel oil pressure measured on the engine (at The main components of the pressurised fuel oil
fuel pump level) should be 78 bar, equivalent to a system are further explained in section 7.05.
circulating pump pressure of 10 bar.
S50MC6
MAN B&W 7.01
Page of 3
&ROMæCENTRIFUGES
!UTæDEAERATINGæVALVE
$ECK
6ENTINGæTANK
!RRæOFæMAINæENGINEæFUELæOILæSYSTEM
3EEæ&IGæ
4OPæOFæFUELæOILæSERVICEæTANK $IESELæ
(EAVYæFUELæOIL OILæ
SERVICEæTANK SERVICEæ
!$ & TANK
!& )FæTHEæFUELæOILæPIPEæTOæENGINEæISæMADEæASæAæSTRAIGHTæLINEæ $
æ
IMMEDIATELYæBEFOREæTHEæENGINEæITæWILLæBEæNECESSARYæTOæ
8 MOUNTæANæEXPANSIONæUNITæ)FæTHEæCONNECTIONæISæMADEæ
"$ ASæINDICATEDæWITHæAæBENDæIMMEDIATELYæBEFOREæTHE
.OæVALVEæINæDRAINæPIPEæ ENGINEæNOæEXPANSIONæUNITæISæREQUIREDæ
BETWEENæENGINEæANDæTANK $
æ
4%ææææ 04ææææ
æMMæ.OMINALæBORE
0) 0) 4) 4) /VERFLOWæVALVE
4Oæ(&/æSETTLINGæTANK !DJUSTEDæTOææBAR
A B
&UELæOIL
DRAINæTANKæ A
OVERFLOWæTANK 4OæJACKETæWATER D
æ
(EATER #IRCULATINGæPUMPS 3UPPLYæPUMPS
COOLINGæPUMP
64ææææ
4OæSLUDGEæTANK
&ULLæFLOWæFILTER
&ORæFILTERæTYPEæSEEæENGINEæSPEC
æ !PPROXIMATELYæTHEæFOLLOWINGæQUANTITYæOFæFUELæOILæSHOULDæBEæTREATEDæIN
æ THEæCENTRIFUGESææLKWHæASæEXPLAINEDæINæ3ECTIONææ4HEæCAPACITYæOF
æ THEæCENTRIFUGESæTOæBEæACCORDINGæTOæMANUFACTURERSæRECOMMENDATION
æ æ $æTOæHAVEæMINææLARGERæPASSAGEæAREAæTHANæD
078 70 37-2.3.0
Diesel oil
Heavy fuel oil
Heated pipe with insulation
a) Tracing fuel oil lines: Max.150 °C
b) Tracing drain lines: By jacket cooling water
S50MC6
MAN B&W 7.01
Page of 3
Fuel considerations
In addition, if this recommendation was not fol- The size of the sludge tank is determined on the
lowed, there would be a latent risk of diesel oil basis of the draining intervals, the classification
and heavy fuels of marginal quality forming in- society rules, and on whether it may be vented
compatible blends during fuel change over or directly to the engine room.
when operating in areas with restrictions on sul-
pher content in fuel oil due to exhaust gas emis- This drained clean oil will, of course, influence the
sion control. measured SFOC, but the oil is thus not wasted,
and the quantity is well within the measuring ac-
In special circumstances a changeover to diesel curacy of the flowmeters normally used.
oil may become necessary – and this can be per-
formed at any time, even when the engine is not For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
running. Such a changeover may become neces- following maximum flow velocities:
sary if, for instance, the vessel is expected to be
inactive for a prolonged period with cold engine Marine diesel oil........................................... 1.0 m/s
e.g. due to: Heavy fuel oil . ............................................. 0.6 m/s
Fuel oils
Marine diesel oil ISO 8217, Class DMB Based on our general service experience we have,
British Standard 6843, Class DMB as a supplement to the above mentioned stand-
Similar oils may also be used ards, drawn up the guiding HFO specification
shown below.
Heavy fuel oil (HFO) Heavy fuel oils limited by this specification have,
to the extent of the commercial availability, been
Most commercially available HFO with a viscosity used with satisfactory results on MAN B&W
below 700 cSt at 50 °C (7,000 sec. Redwood I at twostroke low speed diesel engines.
100 °F) can be used.
The data refers to the fuel as supplied i.e. before
For guidance on purchase, reference is made any on-board cleaning.
to ISO 8217:1996 and ISO 8217:2005, British
Standard 6843 and to CIMAC recommendations Guiding specification (maximum values)
regarding requirements for heavy fuel for diesel
engines, fourth edition 2003, in which the maxi-
Density at 15 °C kg/m3 < 1.010*
mum acceptable grades are RMH 700 and RMK Kinematic viscosity
700. The abovementioned ISO and BS standards at 100 °C cSt < 55
supersede BSMA 100 in which the limit was M9.
at 50 °C cSt < 700
The data in the above HFO standards and speci- Flash point °C > 60
fications refer to fuel as delivered to the ship, i.e. Pour point °C < 30
before on-board cleaning. Carbon residue % (m/m) < 22
Ash % (m/m) < 0.15
In order to ensure effective and sufficient cleaning
of the HFO, i.e. removal of water and solid con- Total sediment potential % (m/m) < 0.10
taminants, the fuel oil specific gravity at 15 °C (60 Water % (v/v) < 0.5
°F) should be below 0.991, unless modern types Sulphur % (m/m) < 4.5
of centrifuges with adequate cleaning abilities are
Vanadium mg/kg < 600
used.
Aluminum + Silicon mg/kg < 80
Higher densities can be allowed if special treat- Equal to ISO 8217:2005 - RMK 700
ment systems are installed. / CIMAC recommendation No. 21 - K700
* Provided automatic clarifiers are installed
Current analysis information is not sufficient for
m/m = mass v/v = volume
estimating the combustion properties of the oil.
This means that service results depend on oil
properties which cannot be known beforehand. If heavy fuel oils with analysis data exceeding the
This especially applies to the tendency of the oil above figures are to be used, especially with re-
to form deposits in combustion chambers, gas gard to viscosity and specific gravity, the engine
passages and turbines. It may, therefore, be nec- builder should be contacted for advice regarding
essary to rule out some oils that cause difficulties. possible fuel oil system changes.
#YL #YL
&UEL &UEL
VALVE VALVE
(IGHæPRESSURE (IGHæPRESSURE
PIPES PIPES
&UEL &UEL
& PUMP PUMP
178 57 51-5.0
#YL 3HOCK
,UBR ABSORBER
"YçPASSæVALVE
04æææææ)ææ!,
0)ææ ,OCALæOPERATIONæPANEL
,3ææææ!(
0)ææ
$RAINæBOXæWITH
LEAKAGEæALARM
!&
3-#ç#æONLY !$ 4OæSLUDGEæTANK
178 57 52-7.0
The letters refer to list of ‘Counterflanges’
The item Nos refer to ‘Guidance values automation’
Insulation of fuel oil pipes and fuel oil drain pipes Flanges and valves
should not be carried out until the piping systems
have been subjected to the pressure tests speci- The flanges and valves are to be insulated by
fied and approved by the respective classification means of removable pads. Flange and valve pads
society and/or authorities, Fig. 7.04.01. are made of glass cloth, minimum 400 g/m2,
containing mineral wool stuffed to minimum 150
The directions mentioned below include insulation kg/m3.
of hot pipes, flanges and valves with a surface
temperature of the complete insulation of maxi- Thickness of the pads to be:
mum 55 °C at a room temperature of maximum 38 Fuel oil pipes................................................. 20 mm
°C. As for the choice of material and, if required, Fuel oil pipes and heating pipes together..... 30 mm
approval for the specific purpose, reference is
made to the respective classification society. The pads are to be fitted so that they lap over the
pipe insulating material by the pad thickness. At
flanged joints, insulating material on pipes should
Fuel oil pipes not be fitted closer than corresponding to the
minimum bolt length.
The pipes are to be insulated with 20 mm mineral
wool of minimum 150 kg/m3 and covered with
glass cloth of minimum 400 g/m2. Mounting
!ç!
&UELæOILæINLET
(EATINGæPIPE
% &UELæOILæOUTLET
3EENæFROMæCYLæSIDE
(EATINGæPIPE
#YLæ &ORE
!$
!&
"$
Fig. 7.04.01: Details of fuel oil pipes insulation, option: 4 35 121. Example from 98-50 MC engine 178 50 65 0.2
20
30
s
es
40
kn
ic
50
th
n
60
tio
su 70 0
la
In 8 0
9 0
10 0
12
0
16
0
20
The steam tracing of the fuel oil pipes is intended 2. When the circulation pump is stopped with
to operate in two situations: heavy fuel oil in the piping and the pipes have
cooled down to engine room temperature, as
1. When the circulation pump is running, there it is not possible to pump the heavy fuel oil.
will be a temperature loss in the piping, see In this situation the fuel oil must be heated to
Fig. 7.04.02. This loss is very small, therefore pumping temperature of about 50 ºC.
tracing in this situation is only necessary with
very long fuel supply lines. To heat the pipe to pumping level we recom-
mend to use 100 watt leaking/meter pipe.
&RESHæCOOLING
,
#YLæ WATERæOUTLET
&UELæVALVE
3HOCKæABSORBER $RAINæCYLæFRAME
3EEæDRAWING
&UELæPUMP
&UELæOILæPIPESæINSULATION
&
"8
!&
!$
"$
8
"&
In order to fulfil IMO regulations, fuel oil and lubri- To avoid leaks, the spray shields are to be in-
cating oil pipe assemblies are to be enclosed by stalled after pressure testing of the pipe system.
spray shields as shown in Fig. 7.04.04a and b.
!NTIçSPLASHINGæTAPE #LAMPINGæBANDS
/VERLAP
178 52 555.2
Fig. 7.04.04a: Spray Shields by anti-splashing tape Fig. 7.04.04b: Spray Shields by clamping bands
Fuel oil centrifuges A centrifuge for Marine Diesel Oil (MDO) is not a
must, but if it is decided to install one on board,
The manual cleaning type of centrifuges are not to the capacity should be based on the above rec-
be recommended, neither for attended machinery ommendation, or it should be a centrifuge of the
spaces (AMS) nor for unattended machinery spac- same size as that for lubricating oil.
es (UMS). Centrifuges must be selfcleaning, either
with total discharge or with partial discharge. The Nominal MCR is used to determine the to-
tal installed capacity. Any derating can be taken
Distinction must be made between installations for: into consideration in borderline cases where the
centrifuge that is one step smaller is able to cover
• Specific gravities < 0.991 (corresponding to ISO Specified MCR.
8217 and British Standard 6843 from RMA to
RMH, and CIMAC from A to Hgrades
Fuel oil supply pump
• Specific gravities > 0.991 and (corresponding to
CIMAC Kgrades). This is to be of the screw or gear wheel type.
For the latter specific gravities, the manufacturers Fuel oil viscosity, specified..... up to 700 cSt at 50 °C
have developed special types of centrifuges, e.g.: Fuel oil viscosity maximum........................1000 cSt
Pump head.......................................................4 bar
Alfa Laval.........................................................Alcap Fuel oil flow.......................... see ‘List of capacities’
Westfalia........................................................ Unitrol Delivery pressure.............................................4 bar
Mitsubishi............................................... EHidens II Working temperature.................................... 100 °C
Minimum temperature..................................... 50 °C
The centrifuge should be able to treat approxi-
mately the following quantity of oil: The capacity stated in ‘List of capacities’ is to be ful-
filled with a tolerance of: ÷0% to +15% and shall also
0.23 litres/kWh = 0.17 litres/BHPh be able to cover the backflushing, see ‘Fuel oil filter’.
The size of the centrifuge has to be chosen ac- The capacity stated in ‘List of capacities’ is to be ful-
cording to the supplier’s table valid for the select- filled with a tolerance of: ÷0% to +15% and shall also
ed viscosity of the Heavy Fuel Oil. Normally, two be able to cover the backflushing, see ‘Fuel oil filter’.
centrifuges are installed for Heavy Fuel Oil (HFO),
each with adequate capacity to comply with the Pump head is based on a total pressure drop in
above recommendation. filter and preheater of maximum 1.5 bar.
#
.ORMALæHEATINGæLIMIT
!PPROXIMATEæPUMPINGæLIMIT
C34#
C34#
SEC2Wæ&
178 06 280.1
The heater is to be of the tube or plate heat ex- Fuel oil viscosity specified.... up to 700 cSt at 50°C
changer type. Fuel oil flow..................................... see capacity of
fuel oil circulating pump
The required heating temperature for different oil Heat dissipation................... see ‘List of capacities’
viscosities will appear from the ‘Fuel oil heating Pressure drop on fuel oil side.........maximum 1 bar
chart’. The chart is based on information from oil Working pressure........................................... 10 bar
suppliers regarding typical marine fuels with vis- Fuel oil inlet temperature..................approx. 100 °C
cosity index 7080. Fuel oil outlet temperature............................ 150 °C
Steam supply, saturated...........................7 bar abs
Since the viscosity after the heater is the control-
led parameter, the heating temperature may vary, To maintain a correct and constant viscosity of
depending on the viscosity and viscosity index of the fuel oil at the inlet to the main engine, the
the fuel. steam supply shall be automatically controlled,
usually based on a pneumatic or an electrically
Recommended viscosity meter setting is 1015 cSt. controlled system.
The filter can be of the manually cleaned duplex The design of the Fuel oil venting box is shown in
type or an automatic filter with a manually cleaned Fig. 7.05.02. The size is chosen according to the
bypass filter. maximum flow of the Fuel oil circulation pump,
which is listed in section 6.03.
If a double filter (duplex) is installed, it should
have sufficient capacity to allow the specified full 6ENTæPIPE
NOMINALæ$
amount of oil to flow through each side of the filter
at a given working temperature with a max. 0.3
bar pressure drop across the filter (clean filter). #ONE
(
If a filter with backflushing arrangement is
installed, the following should be noted. The
required oil flow specified in the ‘List of capaci-
ties’, i.e. the delivery rate of the fuel oil supply
pump and the fuel oil circulating pump, should
be increased by the amount of oil used for the 4OPæOFæFUELæOILæ
SERVICEæTANK
backflushing, so that the fuel oil pressure at the
(
(
In those cases where an automatically cleaned
filter is installed, it should be noted that in order
to activate the cleaning process, certain makers
of filters require a greater oil pressure at the inlet 0IPE
NOMINALæ$
to the filter than the pump pressure specified.
Therefore, the pump capacity should be adequate
for this purpose, too.
(
/UTLETæPIPE
NOMINALæ$
The fuel oil filter should be based on heavy fuel oil
178 38 393.3
of: 130 cSt at 80 °C = 700 cSt at 50 °C = 7000 sec
Redwood I/100 °F. Flow m3/h Dimensions in mm
Q (max.)* D1 D2 D3 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5
Fuel oil flow.......................... see ‘List of capacities’ 1.3 150 32 15 100 600 171.3 1,000 550
Working pressure........................................... 10 bar 2.1 150 40 15 100 600 171.3 1,000 550
Test pressure....................... according to class rule 5.0 200 65 15 100 600 171.3 1,000 550
Absolute fineness........................................... 50 µm 8.4 400 80 15 150 1,200 333.5 1,800 1,100
Working temperature................... maximum 150 °C 11.5 400 90 15 150 1,200 333.5 1,800 1,100
Oil viscosity at working temperature.............15 cSt 19.5 400 125 15 150 1,200 333.5 1,800 1,100
29.4 500 150 15 150 1,500 402.4 2,150 1,350
Pressure drop at clean filter.........maximum 0.3 bar
43.0 500 200 15 150 1,500 402.4 2,150 1,350
Filter to be cleaned at a pressure
* The maximum flow of the fuel oil circulation pump
drop of . .......................................maximum 0.5 bar
Fig. 07.05.02: Fuel oil venting box
Note:
Absolute fineness corresponds to a nominal fine-
ness of approximately 30 µm at a retaining rate of Flushing of the fuel oil system
90%.
Before starting the engine for the first time, the
The filter housing shall be fitted with a steam jack- system on board has to be flushed in accordance
et for heat tracing. with MAN Diesel’s recommendations ‘Flushing of
Fuel Oil System’ which is available on request.
The higher temperature calls for a higher pressure For further information about emulsification of wa-
to prevent cavitation and steam formation in the ter into the fuel and use of Water In Fuel emulsion
system. The inlet pressure is thus set to 13 bar. (WIF), please refer to our publication titled:
In order to avoid temperature chock when mixing Exhaust Gas Emission Control Today and
water into the fuel in the homogeniser, the water Tomorrow
inlet temperature is to be set to 7090 °C.
The publication is available at: www.mandiesel.com
under ‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers
&ROM
CENTRIFUGES $ECK
!UTOMATIC
4OæSPECIAL DEçAERATING $EçAERATINGæTOæBEæ
SAFETYæTANK VALVE CONTROLLEDæAGAINSTæ
EXPANSIONæOFæWATER
6ENTINGæBOX
4Oæ(&/ "& !$
&æ/æSPECIAL SERVICEæOR !& "$
SAFETYæTANK SETTLINGæTANK
#OMMONæFUELæOILæSUPPLYæUNIT æMM
.OM
/VERFLOWæVALVE BORE
ADJUSTEDæTO B
æBAR &ULLæFLOW A
(OMOGENISER FILTER -AINæENGINE
3UPPLYæPUMPS
7ATERæINæOIL &/
MEASURING DRAIN
&ILTER
"OOSTER TANK
PUMP 4Oæ(&/æSERVICE
ORæSETTLINGæTANK
#IRCULATING (EATER
&RESHæWATER
#OMPRESSED PUMPS
SUPPLY
AIR
@3 3AFETYæPUMP
3UPPLYæAIRæTANK AIRæOPERATED
! ! !
! ! !
! ! !
'EN3ET 'EN3ET 'EN3ET
&UELæOIL
4Oæ(&/æSERVICE SLUDGEæTANK 4OæFRESHWATERæCOOLING
ORæSETTLINGæTANK PUMPæSUCTION
a) Tracing fuel oil lines: Max. 150 °C The letters refer to the list of ‘Counterflanges’.
b) Tracing fuel oil drain lines: Max. 90 °C,
min. 50 °C for installations with jacket cooling water
198 99 018.3
Fig. 7.06.01: System for emulsification of water into the fuel common to the main engine and MAN Diesel GenSets
Lubricating Oil
8
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 8.01
Page of 2
%NGINE
OIL
4OæDRAINæTANK
-INæª
!2
!"
&EELERææª# &ULLæFLOWæFILTER
ææ
,UBEOIL $EçAERATION
COOLER
ææ
#$
,UBEæOILæBOTTOMæTANK
&ORæINITIALæFILLLINGæOFæPUMPS #$
0OSæææMMæVALVE
FORæCLEANINGæPROCESS &ROMæPURIFIER 4OæPURIFIER
,UBEæOILæPUMPS
ææ
Since mid-1995 we have introduced, as standard, The engine crankcase is vented through ‘AR’ by a
the socalled ‘umbrella’ type of fuel pump for which pipe which extends directly to the deck. This pipe
reason a separate camshaft lube oil system is no has a drain arrangement so that oil condensed in
longer necessary. the pipe can be led to a drain tank, see details in
Fig. 8.07.01.
The lubricating oil is pumped from a bottom tank,
by means of the main lubricating oil pump (4 40 Drains from the engine bedplate ‘AE’ are fitted on
601), to the lubricating oil cooler (4 40 605), a ther- both sides, see Fig. 8.07.02 ‘Bedplate drain pipes’.
mostatic valve (4 40 610) and, through a fullflow
filter (4 40 615), to the engine inlet RU, Fig. 8.01.01. For external pipe connections, we prescribe a
maximum oil velocity of 1.8 m/s.
RU lubricates main bearings, thrust bearing, axial
vibration damper, crankpin bearings, piston cooling,
crosshead, camshaft and turbo charger bearings. Lubrication of turbochargers
The major part of the oil is divided between piston Turbochargers with slide bearings are normally
cooling and crosshead lubrication. lubricated from the main engine system. AB is
outlet from the turbocharger, see Figs. 8.03.01 to
From the engine, the oil collects in the oil pan, 8.03.03, which are shown with sensors for UMS.
from where it is drained off to the bottom tank,
see Fig. 8.06.01a ‘Lubricating oil tank, with cof- Figs. 8.03.01 to 8.03.03 show the lube oil pipe ar-
ferdam’ and Table 8.06.01b ‘Lubricating oil tank, rangements for different turbocharger makes.
without cofferdam’.
4)ææ
&3ææææ!,ææ9
4%ææææ)ææ!(ææ9
4)ææ
43ææææ:
4%ææææ)ææ!(
#AMSHAFTæANDæEXHAUSTæVALVEæACTUATORæLUBRæOILæSYSTEM
!FT &ORE
3TARTINGæAIR
DISTRIBUTOR
#YLæLUBæDRIVEæ-ECHANICALæLUBRICATOR
-AINæBEARINGS
#ROSSHEADæBEARINGSææPISTON
!XIALæVIBRATIONæDAMPER
7)ææ
74ææææ)ææ!(ææ9ææ
4HRUSTæBEARING /NLYææ3,-#ç#
4OæCHAINæDRIVE 3
!2 4OæNDæORDERæMOMENTæCOMPENSATOR
FOREæENDæIFæMOUNTED
3YSTEMæOILæOUTLET
,UBRæOILæTOæTURBOCHARGER
0)ææ
04ææææ)ææ!,ææ9ææ
03ææææ:
4%ææææ)ææ!(ææ!,
4)ææ
25
121 00 99-5.1.0
&ROMæSYSTEMæOIL
0)æææ
-!.æ$IESELæ4#!
TURBOCHARGER
4)æææ 04ææææææ)æææ!,
4%ææææææ)ææ!(
!"
PI 803
PT 803 I AL
ABB TPL
turbocharger TI 87
TE 87 I AH
AB
E PI 803
MET turbocharger
TI 87
TE 87 I AH
AB
0.136 litre/kWh
Circulating oil
Company SAE 30/TBN 510
BP Energol OEHT/30
Total Atlanta Marine D3005
Castrol CDX 30
Chevron Veritas 800 Marine 30
Exxon Exxmar XA
Mobil Mobilgard 300
Shell Melina 30/30S
Texaco Doro AR 30
The lubricating oil pump can be of the displace- The lubricating oil cooler must be of the shell and
ment wheel, or the centrifugal type: tube type made of seawater resistant material, or
a plate type heat exchanger with plate material
Lubricating oil viscosity, specified...75 cSt at 50 °C of titanium, unless freshwater is used in a central
Lubricating oil viscosity........... maximum 400 cSt * cooling water system.
Lubricating oil flow............... see ‘List of capacities’
Design pump head........................................ 4.1 bar Lubricating oil viscosity, specified...75 cSt at 50 °C
Delivery pressure.......................................... 4.1 bar Lubricating oil flow............... see ‘List of capacities’
Max. working temperature.............................. 70 °C Heat dissipation................... see ‘List of capacities’
Lubricating oil temperature, outlet cooler....... 45 °C
* 400 cSt is specified, as it is normal practice when Working pressure on oil side........................ 4.1 bar
starting on cold oil, to partly open the bypass Pressure drop on oil side.............maximum 0.5 bar
valves of the lubricating oil pumps, so as to reduce Cooling water flow............... see ‘List of capacities’
the electric power requirements for the pumps. Cooling water temperature at inlet:
seawater.......................................................... 32 °C
The flow capacity must be within a range from freshwater........................................................ 36 °C
100 to 112% of the capacity stated. Pressure drop on water side........maximum 0.2 bar
The pump head is based on a total pressure drop The lubricating oil flow capacity must be within a
across cooler and filter of maximum 1 bar. range from 100 to 112% of the capacity stated.
The bypass valve shown between the main lubri- The cooling water flow capacity must be within a
cating oil pumps Fig. 8.01.01 may be omitted in range from 100 to 110% of the capacity stated.
cases where the pumps have a builtin bypass or
if centrifugal pumps are used. To ensure the correct functioning of the lubricat-
ing oil cooler, we recommend that the seawater
If centrifugal pumps are used, it is recommended temperature is regulated so that it will not be
to install a throttle valve at position ‘005’ to prevent lower than 10 °C.
an excessive oil level in the oil pan if the centrifugal
pump is supplying too much oil to the engine. The pressure drop may be larger, depending on
the actual cooler design.
During trials, the valve should be adjusted by
means of a device which permits the valve to be
closed only to the extent that the minimum flow Lubricating oil temperature control valve
area through the valve gives the specified lubri-
cating oil pressure at the inlet to the engine at full The temperature control system can, by means of
normal load conditions. It should be possible to a threeway valve unit, bypass the cooler totally
fully open the valve, e.g. when starting the engine or partly.
with cold oil.
Lubricating oil viscosity, specified.....75 cSt at 50 °C
It is recommended to install a 25 mm valve (pos. Lubricating oil flow............... see ‘List of capacities’
006), with a hose connection after the main lubri- Temperature range, inlet to engine..........40 47 °C
cating oil pumps, for checking the cleanliness of
the lubricating oil system during the flushing pro-
cedure. The valve is to be located on the under-
side of a horizontal pipe just after the discharge
from the lubricating oil pumps.
Lubricating oil flow............... see ‘List of capacities’ If a filter with a backflushing arrangement is in-
Working pressure.......................................... 4.1 bar stalled, the following should be noted:
Test pressure..................... according to class rules
Absolute fineness..........................................40 µm* • The required oil flow, specified in the ‘List of
Working temperature.............. approximately 45 °C capacities’, should be increased by the amount
Oil viscosity at working temp............... 90 100 cSt of oil used for the backflushing, so that the
Pressure drop with clean filter.....maximum 0.2 bar lubricating oil pressure at the inlet to the main
Filter to be cleaned engine can be maintained during cleaning.
at a pressure drop........................maximum 0.5 bar
• If an automatically cleaned filter is installed, it
* The absolute fineness corresponds to a nominal should be noted that in order to activate the
fineness of approximately 25 µm at a retaining cleaning process, certain makes of filter require
rate of 90%. a higher oil pressure at the inlet to the filter than
the pump pressure specified. Therefore, the
The flow capacity must be within a range from pump capacity should be adequate for this pur-
100 to 112% of the capacity stated. pose, too.
If a double filter (duplex) is installed, it should Before starting the engine for the first time, the lu-
have sufficient capacity to allow the specified full bricating oil system on board has to be cleaned in
amount of oil to flow through each side of the filter accordance with MAN Diesel’s recommendations:
at a given working temperature with a pressure ‘Flushing of Main Lubricating Oil System’, which is
drop across the filter of maximum 0.2 bar (clean available on request.
filter).
178 07 416.0
æææ#YLæ
æææ#YLæ
3EEN¬FROM¬!
!
! "
/ILæLEVELæWITHæ1M æOILæINæBOTTOM $
,UBæOILæPUMPæSUCTION
TANKæANDæWITHæPUMPSæSTOPPED
-INæHEIGHTæACCæTOæ
/,
CLASSæREQUIREMENT
(
,
( (
! " 7 $
/UTLETæFROMæENGINEææMMæHAVINGæ
ITSæBOTTOMæEDGEæBELOWæTHEæOILæLEVELæ
TOæOBTAINæGASæSEALæBETWEENæCRANKç
CASEæANDæBOTTOMæTANK
3EEN¬FROM¬"
"
æCYL
æMMæAIRæPIPE
æMMæAIRæPIPE
æCYL
/ILæOUTLETæFROMæTURBOCHARGER
3EEæLISTæOFæ@COUNTERFLANGES æMMæAIRæPIPE
(
æCYL
æCYL
æ"ASEDæONææMMæTHICKNESSæOFæEPOXYæCHOCKS
æCYL
#YLæNO
178 23 582.1
Cylin- Drain at
D0 D1 H0 H1 H2 H3 W L OL Qm3
der No. cylinder No.
5 25 225 450 1,045 450 90 300 400 6,750 945 15.5
6 25 250 475 1,145 475 95 400 500 7,500 1,045 19.0
7 257 275 550 1,170 550 110 400 500 8,250 1,075 21.5
8 258 300 600 1,240 600 110 400 500 9,750 1,140 27.0
9 2-5-7-9 300 600 1,290 600 110 400 600 11,250 1,190 32.5
$ECK
)NSIDEæDIAMæOFæPIPEææMM
4OæDRAINæTANK
4OæBEæLAIDæWITHæINCLINATION
6ENTINGæFROMæCRANKCASE
INSIDEæDIAMæOFæPIPEææMM
(OLEæDIAMææMM
4OæBEæEQUIPPEDæWITHæFLAMEæSCREEN
IFæREQUIREDæBYæCLASSæRULES
6APOURæDISCHARGE
$RAINæCOWL !2 FROMæENGINE
)NSIDEæDIAMETER 4HISæPIPEæTOæBE
OFæDRAINæPIPEææMM DELIVEREDæWITHæTHEæENGINE
178 57 78-0.0
Cyl. 1
AE
Drain from
exhaust side
Fore
AE
178 57 58-8.0
Cylinder Lubrication
9
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 9.01
Page of 1
The cost of the cylinder lubricating oil is one of the Modern highrated twostroke engines have a
largest contributions to total operating costs, next relatively great demand for detergency in the cyl-
to the fuel oil cost. Another aspect is that the lu- inder oil. Therefore cylinder oils should be chosen
brication rate has a great influence on the cylinder according to the below list.
condition, and thus on the overhauling schedules
and maintenance costs. A BN 70 cylinder oil is to be used as the default
choice of oil and it may be used on all fuel types.
It is therefore of the utmost importance that the However, in case of the engine running on fuel
cylinder lubricating oil system as well as its opera- with sulphur content lower than 1.5 % for more
tion is optimised. than 1 to 2 weeks, we recommend to change to a
lower BN cylinder oil such as BN 40-50.
Cylinder Lubricator and Service Tank The cylinder oils listed below have all given long-
term satisfactory service during heavy fuel opera-
As standard the engine is specified with MAN tion in MAN B&W engine installations:
B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators (EoD: 4 42 104).
Alternatively a mechanical cylinder lubricator driv- Company Cylinder oil Cylinder oil
en by the engine can be installed. SAE 50/BN 70 SAE 50/BN 40-50
BP CLO50 M CL/CL-DX 405
The cylinder lube oil is supplied from a gravity- Castrol Cyltech 70 CL/CL-DX 405
feed cylinder oil service tank to where it is being Chevron Delo Cyloil Special Taro Special HT 50
Exxon Exxmar X 70 Mobilgard L540
pumped from the cylinder oil storage tank. The
Mobil Mobilgard 570 Mobilgard L540
size of the cylinder oil service tank depends on
Shell Alexia 50 Alexia LS
the owner’s and yard’s requirements, and it is Texaco Taro Special HT 70 Taro Special HT 50
normally dimensioned for minimum two days’ Total Talusia HR70 Talusia LS 40
consumption.
The cylinder lubricating oil consumption could be Also other brands have been used with satisfac-
monitored by installing a flow meter on the pres- tory results.
sure side of the pump in the supply line to the
service tank, if required by the shipowner. Pro-
vided the oil level in the service tank is kept the Cylinder Oil Feed Rate (Dosage)
same every time the flow meter is being read, the
accuracy is satisfactory. The recommendations are valid for all plants,
whether controllable pitch or fixed pitch propellers
A cylinder lubricating oil supply system for engine are used.
plants with MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder lubrica-
tors is shown in Fig. 9.02.02 and for plants with In case of average sulphur content, the average
mechanical cylinder lubricators in Fig. 9.03.03. In cylinder oil feed rate at nominal MCR for MAN
both cases a dual system for supply of two differ- B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricator is 0.7 g/kWh. Ad-
ent BN cylinder oils is shown. justment of the cylinder oil dosage of the MAN
B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricator to the sulphur
content in the fuel being burnt is further explained
Cylinder Oils in section 9.02.
Cylinder oils should, preferably, be of the SAE 50 The nominal cylinder oil feed rate at nominal MCR
viscosity grade. for a mechanical cylinder lubricator is typically
0.8 - 1.2 g/kWh.
The MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system, System control units
see Figs. 9.02.02 and 9.02.03, is designed to sup-
ply cylinder oil intermittently, every 2 to 20 engine The cylinder lubrication system is controlled by
revolutions with electronically controlled timing the Master Control Unit (MCU) which calculates
and dosage at a defined position. the injection frequency on the basis of the engine-
speed signal given by the tacho signal (ZE) and
Cylinder lubricating oil is fed to the engine by the fuel index.
means of a pump station which as standard is
mounted on the engine (EoD: 4 42 150) or could Lubricating control functions such as ‘mep de-
be placed in the engine room (option: 4 42 152). pendent’ and ‘load change dependent’ are all
incorporated in the MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lu-
The pump station has two pumps (one operating, brication system.
the other stand-by with automatic start up) with
in-line filters and a heater, see Fig. 9.02.02. The MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricator is pre
ferably to be controlled in accordance with the
The oil fed to the injectors is pressurised by Alpha Adaptive Cylinder oil Control (Alpha ACC)
means of one or two Alpha Lubricators placed feed rate system. The Alpha ACC is explained in
on each cylinder and equipped with small the following page.
multipiston pumps, see Fig. 9.02.03.
The MCU is equipped with a Backup Control Unit
Accumulator tanks on the lubricator inlet pipes (BCU) which, if the MCU malfunctions, activates
ensure adequate filling of the lubricator while ac- an alarm and takes control automatically or manu-
cumulators on the outlet pipes serve to dampen ally, via a Switch Board Unit (SBU), Fig. 9.02.04.
the pressure fluctuations. The oil pipes fitted on
the engine is shown in Fig. 9.02.03. The MCU, BCU and SBU together comprise the
Alpha Cylinder Lubricator Control Unit (ALCU) in
On engines with double lubricators, a by-pass shape of a single steel cabinet which is, as stand-
valve allows for circulating and heating the cyl- ard, located in the Engine Control Room. Fig.
inder oil before starting the engine under cold 9.02.05 shows the wiring diagram for the MAN
engine room conditions. On engines with one lu- B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System.
bricator per cylinder, this is done by means of the
valve on the cylinderblock intended for emptying The yard supply should be according to the items
the accumulator. shown in Fig. 9.02.02 within the broken line.
It is a wellknown fact that the actual need for Safe and very lubricatingeconomical control after
cylinder oil quantity varies with the operational running-in is obtained with a basic setting accord-
conditions such as load and fuel oil quality. Con- ing to the formula:
sequently, in order to perform the optimal lubrica-
tion – costeffectively as well as technically – the Basic lubricating oil setting = 0,26 g/kWh x S%
cylinder lubricating oil dosage should follow such
operational variations accordingly. with a minimum setting of 0,60 g/kWh, i.e. the
setting should be kept constant from about 2.3%
The Alpha lubricating system offers the possibility sulphur and downwards.
of saving a considerable amount of cylinder lubri-
cating oil per year and, at the same time, to obtain
a safer and more predictable cylinder condition.
The name of the algorithm which controls the
!BSOLUTE¬DOSAGE¬GK7H
2UNNINGçINæRANGE
cylinder oil dosage proportional to the sulphur
ing burnt at any given time. The sulphur percent- 178 59 494.0
age is a good indicator in relation to wear, and an
oil dosage proportional to the sulphur level will Fig 9.02.01: Cylinder lubricating oil dosage with
give the best overall cylinder condition. Alpha ACC at nominal MCR (BN 70 cylinder oil)
$ECK
3ERVICEæTANK 3ERVICEæTANK
&ILLINGæPIPE FORæLOWæ". FORæHIGHæ". &ILLINGæPIPE
CYLINDERæOIL CYLINDERæOIL
&LOWæMETER
&LOWæMETER
& ,3 ,3 &
)NTERæLOCK
MMæNOMINALæBORE
3TORAGEæTANK 3TORAGEæTANK
FORæLOWæ". FORæHIGHæ".
CYLINDERæOIL CYLINDERæOIL
-INæMM
3HIPæBUILDER
3HIPæBUILDER
$. $.
$.
!# !5
!#
æ)FæPUMPæSTATIONæISæPLACEDæONæENGINE 0UMP
æ)FæPUMPæSTATIONæISæPLACEDæINæENGINEæROOM STATION
æ)FæREQUIREDæBYæTHEæSHIPOWNER
!5
$.
Fig. 9.02.02: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN oils
#YLINDER
:6ææææææ# 3OLENOIDæVALVE
!CCUMULATOR ,UBRICATOR
:4ææææææ# &EEDçBACKæSENSOR
!CCU
#IRCULATIONæVALVEæææ
!5
!#
The letters refer to list of ‘Counterflanges’ #) In case of COLD engine room conditions, open the valve
The item No. refer to ‘Guidance values Automation’ to circulate and heat up the cylinder oil. The valve is then
to be closed before starting.
121 36 61-8.4.0c
Fig. 9.02.03: MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubricators with piping and instrumentation on engine
The external electrical system must be capable of and slow down (Normally Open) for:
providing the MCU and BCU with an un-interrupt-
ible supply of 24 Volt DC power. • Electronic cylinder lubricator system
The MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricator System The system has a connection for coupling it to a
is equipped with the following (Normally Closed) computer system or a Display Unit (HMI panel) so
alarms: that engine speed, fuel index, injection frequency,
alarms, etc. can be monitored.
• MCU fail
• MCU power fail The HMI panel for mounting in Engine Control
• MCU common alarm Room (option: 4 42 660) or on the engine (option:
• BCU in control 4 42 160) can be delivered separately.
• BCU fail
• BCU power fail
#YLINDER
3OLENOIDæVALVE
!CCUç
,UBRICATOR
MULATOR
3ENSOR
!5 0UMPæSTATION
WITH 4OæOTHERæCYLINDERS
!# STANDçBYæPUMP
0UMPæCONTROL
UNIT
4OæOTHERæ
CYLINDERS
!LARM
4ACHOæSIGNAL
3WITCH "ACKUP -ASTER SYSTEM
"OARD #ONTROL #ONTROL
5NIT 5NIT 5NIT
3AFETY
)NDEXæSIGNAL
SYSTEM
!LPHAæ#YLINDERæ,UBRICATORæ#ONTROLæ5NIT
(-)æPANEL
For the actual number of cylinder lubrication points on the specific engine see Fig. 9.02.03
178 47 13-9.3
Fig. 9.02.04: Control of the MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System, one lubricator per cylinder
Wiring Diagram
4%
0REçLUBRICATION
0%
!LARM
SYSTEM
!LPHAæ,UBRICATOR
0UMPæ
#ONTROLæ5NIT
CONTROLæUNIT
!,#5
3LOWæDOWN
SYSTEM
5NçINTERRUPTIBLE
POWERæSUPPLY
$ISPLAYæUNIT
(-)æPANEL
)NTERMEDIATE )NTERMEDIATE )NTERMEDIATE
BOX BOX BOX
:% :% :% :%
,UBRIç
CATOR
0ICKçUPS 4ACHO )NDEX
SIGNAL SIGNAL
0ERæCYLINDER
178 47 16-4.2
Fig. 9.02.05: Wiring diagram for MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System, one lubricators per cylinder
Mechanical cylinder lubricator(s), can be mounted Mainly for plants with controllable pitch propeller,
on the fore end of the engine, the size of which will the lubricators could, alternatively, be fitted with a
decide the number of lubricators needed. If driven mechanical lubrication system which controls the
by the engine in sync with the crankshaft move- dosage in proportion to the Mean Effective Pres-
ment, the lubricators could deliver timed injection sure (MEP).
of the cylinder lubrication oil.
An ‘Engine Speed Dependent’ as well as a ‘MEP
The lubricator(s) should have a built-in capability Dependent’ mechanical lubricator could be
for adjustment of the oil quantity and be provided equipped with a ‘Load Change Dependent’ sys-
with a sight glass for each lubricating point. tem, by which the cylinder feed oil rate is auto-
matically increased during starting, manoeuvring
The lubricators should be fitted with: and, preferably, during sudden load changes, see
• Electric heating coils Fig. 9.03.02.
• Low flow and low level alarms.
In that case, the signal for the ‘Load Change De-
In the ‘Engine Speed Dependent’ design, the lu- pendent’ system comes from the electronic gov-
bricator pumps a fixed amount of oil to the cylin- ernor.
ders for each engine revolution.
&ORE !FT
#ONTROLæAIRæFROMæ %LECTRONICæGOVERNOR
MANOEUVRINGæSYSTEM DIGITALæTYPE
æBAR
,3ææææ!,
&3ææææ!,
3OLENOIDæVALVE
!#
,UBRICATOR
çæCYLINDERæENGINESææ,UBRICATORS
çæCYLINDERæENGINESææ,UBRICATORS
178 59 504.0
The letters refer to list of ‘Counterflanges’ Fig 9.03.02: Load change dependent mechanical lubri-
The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine cator
178 57 718.0
$ECK
3ERVICEæTANK 3ERVICEæTANK
FORæLOWæ". FORæHIGHæ".
CYLINDERæOIL CYLINDERæOIL
&ILLINGæPIPE &ILLINGæPIPE
&LOWæMETER &LOWæMETER
& &
-INæMM
3TORAGEæTANK 3TORAGEæTANK
FORæLOWæ". !# FORæHIGHæ".
CYLINDERæOIL CYLINDERæOIL
MMæNOMINALæBORE
æ)FæREQUIREDæBYæTHEæSHIPOWNER
Fig. 9.03.03: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN cylinder oils, for mechanical lubricators
10
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 10.01
Page of 1
The relatively small amount of drain oil is led to Oily waste drain tank
Drain
the general oily waste drain tank or is burnt in the tank
Central Cooling
Water System
11
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 11.01
Page of 1
Advantages of the central cooling system: An arrangement common for the main engine
and MAN Diesel auxiliary engines is available on
• Only one heat exchanger cooled by seawater, request.
and thus, only one exchanger to be overhauled
For further information about common cooling
• All other heat exchangers are freshwater cooled water system for main engines and auxiliary en-
and can, therefore, be made of a less expensive gines please refer to our publication:
material
Uniconcept Auxiliary Systems for Twostroke Main
• Few noncorrosive pipes to be installed
The publication is available at www.mandiesel.com
• Reduced maintenance of coolers and compo- under ‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers’
nents
%XPANSIONæTANK
CENTRALæCOOLINGæWATER
04ææææ!,
4HESEæVALVESæTOæBEæPROVIDED
4)ææ 4%ææææ)ææ!, WITHæGRADUATEDæSCALE
3EAWATER
OUTLET
2EGARDINGæTHEæLUBRICATINGæOILæCOOLERS 4)
THISæVALVEæSHOULDæBEæADJUSTEDæSOæTHAT
THEæINLETæTEMPERATUREæOFæTHEæCOOLING 4) 4)
,UBRICATINGæ
WATERæISæNOTæBELOWææª# .
OILæCOOLER
#ENTRAL !3
!IRæPOCKETSæIFæANYæINæTHEæPIPEæLINEæ 0
COOLER 4)
BETWEENæTHEæPUMPSæMUSTæBEæVENTEDæ
TOæTHEæEXPANSIONæTANK
0) 4) 0) 4)
0) 4)
#OOLINGæWATER
DRAINæAIRæCOOLER
3EAWATER
INLET
3EAWATER
INLET
*ACKETæCOOLINGæWATER
3EAæWATER
&UELæOIL
4HEæLETTERSæREFERæTOæLISTæOFæ@#OUNTERFLANGESæ&IGææ
178 52 771.1
The central cooling water system is characterised air cooler as low as possible also applies to the
by having only one heat exchanger cooled by central cooling system. This means that the tem-
seawater, and by the other coolers, including the perature control valve in the central cooling water
jacket water cooler, being cooled by central cool- circuit is to be set to minimum 10 °C, whereby the
ing water. temperature follows the outboard seawater tem-
perature when central cooling water temperature
In order to prevent too high a scavenge air tem- exceeds 10 °C.
perature, the cooling water design temperature
in the central cooling water system is normally 36 For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
°C, corresponding to a maximum seawater tem- following maximum water velocities:
perature of 32 °C.
Jacket water................................................. 3.0 m/s
Our recommendation of keeping the cooling water Central cooling water................................... 3.0 m/s
inlet temperature to the main engine scavenge Seawater...................................................... 3.0 m/s
The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type.
Seawater flow....................... see ‘List of capacities’ Central cooling water flow..... see ‘List of capacities’
Pump head....................................................2.5 bar Pump head....................................................2.5 bar
Test pressure..................... according to class rules Delivery pressure................depends on location of
Working temperature, normal......................032 °C expansion tank
Working temperature..................... maximum 50 °C Test pressure..................... according to class rules
Working temperature...................................... 80 °C
The capacity is to be within a tolerance of 0% to Design temperature...................................... 100 °C
+10%.
The flow capacity is to be within a tolerance of 0%
The differential pressure of the pumps is to be de- to +10%.
termined on the basis of the total actual pressure
drop across the cooling water system. The list of capacities covers the main engine only.
The differential pressure provided by the pumps
is to be determined on the basis of the total actual
Central cooler pressure drop across the cooling water system.
Due to the central cooler the cooling water inlet See chapter 8 ‘Lubricating Oil’.
temperature is about 4 °C higher for for this sys-
tem compared to the seawater cooling system.
The input data are therefore different for the scav- Jacket water cooler
enge air cooler, the lube oil cooler and the jacket
water cooler. The cooler is to be of the shell and tube or plate
heat exchanger type.
The heat dissipation and the central cooling water
flow figures are based on an MCR output at tropi- Heat dissipation................... see ‘List of capacities’
cal conditions, i.e. a maximum seawater tempera- Jacket water flow................. see ‘List of capacities’
ture of 32 °C and an ambient air temperature of Jacket water temperature, inlet...................... 80 °C
45 °C. Pressure drop on jacket water side ....max. 0.2 bar
Central cooling water flow..... see ‘List of capacities’
Central cooling water
Jacket water cooling pump temperature, inlet...............................approx. 42 °C
Pressure drop on Central
The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. cooling water side.................................max. 0.2 bar
Jacket water flow................. see ‘List of capacities’
Pump head....................................................3.0 bar The other data for the jacket cooling water system
Delivery pressure................depends on location of can be found in chapter 12.
expansion tank
Test pressure..................... according to class rules For further information about a common cooling
Working temperature...................................... 80 °C water system for main engines and MAN Diesel
Design temperature...................................... 100 °C auxiliary engines, please refer to our publication:
The flow capacity is to be within a tolerance of 0% Uniconcept Auxiliary Systems for Twostroke Main
to +10%.
The publication is available at www.mandiesel.com
The stated of capacities cover the main engine under ‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers’
only. The pump head of the pumps is to be de-
termined on the basis of the total actual pressure
drop across the cooling water system.
Seawater
Cooling System
12
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 12.01
Page of 1
Seawater Systems
The water cooling can be arranged in several con-
figurations, the most simple system choices being
seawater and central cooling water system:
,UBRICATING
3EAWATER OILæCOOLER
PUMPS
4HERMOSTATIC
VALVE 0
3EAWATER
OUTLET
3CAVENGE
AIRæCOOLER
*ACKETæWATER
COOLER
3EAWATER
INLET
3EAWATER
INLET
198 98 132.5
The seawater cooling system is used for cooling, The interrelated positioning of the coolers in the
the main engine lubricating oil cooler, the jacket system serves to achieve:
water cooler and the scavenge air cooler, see Fig.
12.02.01. • The lowest possible cooling water inlet tem-
perature to the lubricating oil cooler in order to
The lubricating oil cooler for a PTO stepup gear obtain the cheapest cooler. On the other hand,
should be connected in parallel with the other in order to prevent the lubricating oil from stiff-
coolers. The capacity of the seawater pump is ening in cold services, the inlet cooling water
based on the outlet temperature of the seawater temperature should not be lower than 10 °C
being maximum 50 °C after passing through the
coolers – with an inlet temperature of maximum • The lowest possible cooling water inlet tempera-
32 °C (tropical conditions), i.e. a maximum tem- ture to the scavenge air cooler, in order to keep
perature increase of 18 °C. the fuel oil consumption as low as possible.
3CAVENGEæ
AIRæCOOLER
4%ææææ)
4)ææ
!3 !3
0
4)ææ 0)ææ
4%ææææ) 04ææææ)ææ!,
178 50 387.0
Fig. 12.03.01: Seawater cooling pipes for engines with one turbochargers
The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. The scavenge air cooler is an integrated part of
the main engine.
Seawater flow....................... see ‘List of capacities’
Pump head....................................................2.5 bar Heat dissipation................... see ‘List of capacities’
Test pressure....................... according to class rule Seawater flow . .................... see ’List of capacities’
Working temperature..................... maximum 50 °C Seawater temperature,
for seawater cooling inlet, max....................... 32 °C
The capacity must be fulfilled with a tolerance of Pressure drop on
between 0% to +10% and covers the cooling of cooling water side............ between 0.1 and 0.5 bar
the main engine only.
The heat dissipation and the seawater flow are
based on an MCR output at tropical conditions,
Lubricating oil cooler i.e. seawater temperature of 32 °C and an ambient
air temperature of 45 °C.
See chapter 8 ‘Lubricating Oil’.
(IGHæLEVELæALARM
6ENTINGæPIPEæORæAUTOMATIC !LARMæMUSTæBEæGIVENæIFæEXCESSæAIR
VENTINGæVALVEæTOæBEæARRANGED ISæSEPARATEDæFROMæTHEæWATERæINæTHE %XPANSIONæTANK
INæONEæENDæOFæDISCHARGEæPIPE DEAERATINGæTANK
/PPOSITEæENDæOFæDISCHARGE
TOæPUMP ,OWæLEVELæALARM
,3ææææ!,
!% !% 0)
$EAERATINGæTANK æ
*ACKETæWATER &RESHWATER
*ACKETæWATERæPUMPS SEEæ&IGæ GENERATOR
COOLER
æBARæHEAD
-AIN
ENGINE
&ROMæTRACINGæOFæFUELæOILæDRAINæPIPEææ
7ATERæINLETæFOR
CLEANINGæTURBOCHARGER
$RAINæFROMæBEDPLATECLEANING
TURBOCHARGERæTOæWASTEæTANK &RESHæCOOLINGæWATERæDRAIN
*ACKETæCOOLINGæWATER
æ&LANGEæ"$æANDæTHEæTRACINGæLINEæAREæNOTæAPPLICABLEæONæ-#æENGINESæTYPEææANDæSMALLER
3EAæWATER
&UELæOIL
4HEæLETTERSæREFERæTOæLISTæOFæ@#OUNTERFLANGESæ&IGæ
178 50 172.3
The jacket cooling water system is used for cool- The venting pipe in the expansion tank should end
ing the cylinder liners, cylinder covers and ex- just below the lowest water level, and the expan-
haust valves of the main engine and heating of the sion tank must be located at least 5 m above the
fuel oil drain pipes, see Fig. 12.05.01. engine cooling water outlet pipe.
The jacket water pump) draws water from the The freshwater generator, if installed, may be con-
jacket water cooler outlet and delivers it to the nected to the seawater system if the generator
engine. does not have a separate cooling water pump.
The generator must be coupled in and out slowly
At the inlet to the jacket water cooler there is a over a period of at least 3 minutes.
thermostatically controlled regulating valve, with
a sensor at the engine cooling water outlet, which For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
keeps the main engine cooling water outlet at a following maximum water velocities:
temperature of 80 °C.
Jacket water................................................. 3.0 m/s
The engine jacket water must be carefully treated, Seawater...................................................... 3.0 m/s
maintained and monitored so as to avoid corro-
sion, corrosion fatigue, cavitation and scale for-
mation. It is recommended to install a preheater
if preheating is not available from the auxiliary
engines jacket cooling water system.
%XHAUSTæVALVEæWATERæDRAINæVALVE
#YLæ
æ
4%ææææ)ææ!(ææ9(
-
-
0$3ææææ!, 4)ææ
4OæHEATINGæFUEL
OILæDRAINæPIPES
!( +
4)ææ
4%ææææ)ææ!,
04ææææ)ææ!,ææ9,
0)ææ ,OCALæOPERATIONæPANEL
03ææææ: /NLYæ',
178 50 471.1
Fig. 12.06.01: Jacket cooling water pipes for engines with MAN Diesel turbochargers, type TCA, ABB turbochargers,
type TPL, Mitsubishi turbochargers, type MET
Jacket water cooling pump The sensor is to be located at the outlet from the
main engine, and the temperature level must be
The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. adjustable in the range of 7090 °C.
Deaerating tank
*
Deaerating tank dimensions
Tank size 0.05 m3 0.16 m3
"
(
B 125 210
!
%
'
C 5 5
D 150 150
$
E 300 500
+
F 910 1,195
)
G 250 350
øH 300 500
øI 320 520
øJ ND 50 ND 80
øK ND 32 ND 50
178 06 279.2 In order not to impede the rotation of water, the pipe connec-
Fig. 12.07.01: Deaerating tank, option: 4 46 640 tion must end flush with the tank, so that no internal edges are
protruding.
%XPANSIONæTANK
,3ææææææ!,
,EVELæSWITCHæFLOAT
!LARMæDEVICE
,EVELæSWITCH
,EVELæSWITCHæFLOAT ,EVELæSWITCHæFLOAT
INæPOSITIONæFORæALARM INæNORMALæPOSITIONæçæNOæALARM
&ROMæDEAERATINGæTANK
198 97 091.1
starting.
Normally, a minimum engine jacket water temper-
ature of 50 °C is recommended before the engine
is started and run up gradually to 90% of speci-
fied MCR speed.
For running between 90% and 100% of specified
MCR speed, it is recommended that the load be
increased slowly – i.e. over a period of 30 minutes.
However, before exceeding 90% specified MCR Fig. 12.08.01: Jacket water preheater
speed, a minimum engine temperature of 50 °C
should be obtained and, increased slowly – i.e.
over a period of at least 30 minutes. Preheating of diesel engine
13
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 13.01
Page of 1
2EDUCTIONæVALVE
2EDUCTIONæSTATION
0IPEæ$.æMM 4OæFUELæVALVE
TESTINGæUNIT
3TARTINGæAIR
&ILTER RECEIVERææBAR
æ«M
!IRæINLETæFOR
TURBOCHARGERæCLEANING 0)
4O
BILGE
"# !0
!
/ILææWATER
SEPARATOR
3TARTINGæAIR
RECEIVERææBAR
0)
æ4OæBILGE
!IRæCOMPRESSORS
The starting air of 30 bar is supplied by the start- Please note that the air consumption for control
ing air compressors to the starting air receivers air, safety air, turbocharger cleaning and for fuel
and from these to the main engine inlet ‘A’. valve testing unit are momentary requirements of
the consumers.
Through a reduction station, filtered compressed
air at 7 bar is supplied to the engine as: The components of the starting and control air
systems are further desribed in Section 13.02.
• Control air for manoeuvring system and for ex-
haust valve air springs, through engine inlet ‘B’ For information about a common starting air sys-
tem for main engines and MAN Diesel auxiliary
• Safety air for emergency stop, through inlet ‘C’. engines, please refer to our publication:
Through a reduction valve, compressed air is sup- Uniconcept Auxiliary Systems for Twostroke Main
plied at 10 bar to ‘AP’ for turbocharger cleaning
(soft blast), and a minor volume used for the fuel The publication is available at www.mandiesel.com
valve testing unit. under ‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers’
The starting air compressors are to be of the Reduction . ........................ from 3010 bar to 7 bar
watercooled, twostage type with intercooling. (Tolerance ±10%)
More than two compressors may be installed to Flow rate, free air ............. 2,600 Normal liters/min
supply the total capacity stated. equal to 0.043 m3/s
Air intake quantity: The consumption of compressed air for control air,
Reversible engine, exhaust valve air springs and safety air as well as
for 12 starts ........................ see ‘List of capacities’ air for turbocharger cleaning and fuel valve testing
Nonreversible engine, is covered by the capacities stated for air receiv-
for 6 starts .......................... see ‘List of capacities’ ers and compressors in the list of capacities.
Delivery pressure ......................................... 30 bar
The volume of the two receivers is: Fig. 13.03.01 Starting air pipes
Reversible engine, Fig. 13.03.02 Air spring pipes, exhaust valves
for 12 starts ...................... see ‘List of capacities’ *
Nonreversible engine,
for 6 starts ........................ see ‘List of capacities’ * Turning gear
Working pressure ......................................... 30 bar
Test pressure .................... according to class rule The turning wheel has cylindrical teeth and is fit-
ted to the thrust shaft. The turning wheel is driven
* The volume stated is at 25 °C and 1,000 mbar by a pinion on the terminal shaft of the turning
gear, which is mounted on the bedplate.
Reduction station for control and safety air Engagement and disengagement of the turning
gear is effected by displacing the pinion and ter-
In normal operating, each of the two lines supplies minal shaft axially. To prevent the main engine
one engine inlet. During maintenance, three isolat- from starting when the turning gear is engaged,
ing valves in the reduction station allow one of the the turning gear is equipped with a safety arrange-
two lines to be shut down while the other line sup- ment which interlocks with the starting air system.
plies both engine inlets, see Fig. 13.01.01.
The turning gear is driven by an electric motor
Reduction . ........................ from 3010 bar to 7 bar with a builtin gear and brake. Key specifications
(Tolerance ±10%) of the electric motor and brake are stated in Sec-
tion 13.04.
Flow rate, free air .............. 2,100 Normal liters/min
equal to 0.035 m3/s
Filter, fineness .............................................. 40 µm
"LOWæOFF
3TARTINGæAIRæDISTRIBUTORæNOææ
3TARTINGæAIRæDISTRIBUTORæNOæ
%XHAUSTæVALVE
ACTUATORæ
#YLæ
3TARTINGæVALVE
"URSTINGæCAP
0UNCTUREæPIPEæONLY
:6ææææææ# æCYLæENGINESæ
"LOW
:6ææææææ# OFF
:3ææææææ# ",/#+%$ "LOWæOFF
:3ææææææ# 3%26)#%
3LOWæTURNING
ææ
-AINæSTARTINGæVALVE !
æ.UMBERæOFæ3TARTINGæAIRæDISTRIBUTORS
04ææææææ)æææ!, æ çæCYLææææPC
0)æææ ,OCALæOPERATIONæPANEL æ çæCYLææææPCS
The starting air pipes, Fig. 13.03.01, contain a Please note that the air consumption for control
main starting valve (a ball valve with actuator), air, turbocharger cleaning and for fuel valve testing
a nonreturn valve, starting air distributor(s) and unit are momentary requirements of the consum-
starting valves. ers.
The main starting valve is combined with the ma- For information about a common starting air sys-
noeuvring system, which controls the start of the tem for main engines and auxiliary engines, please
engine. Slow turning before start of engine is an refer to the Engine Selection Guide or to our pub-
option: 4 50 140 and is recommended by MAN lication:
Diesel, see section 16.01.
Uniconcept Auxiliary Systems for Twostroke Main
The starting air distributor regulates the supply of
control air to the starting valves in accordance The publication is available at www.mandiesel.com
with the correct firing sequence. under ‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers’
S/L60MC-C7/8
MAN B&W 13.03
Page 2 of 2
04ææææææ)æææ!,
MAN Diesel delivers a turning gear with built-in Turning gear with electric motor of other protec-
disc brake, option 40 80 101. Two basic executions tion or insulation classes can be ordered, option
are available for power supply frequencies of 60 40 80 103. Information about the alternative ex-
and 50 Hz respectively. Nominal power and cur- ecutions is available on request.
rent consumption of the motors are listed below.
Electric motor and brake, voltage............. 3 x 440 V Electric motor and brake, voltage............. 3 x 380 V
Electric motor and brake, frequency..............60 Hz Electric motor and brake, frequency..............50 Hz
Protection, electric motor / brake........ IP 55 / IP 54 Protection, electric motor / brake........ IP 55 / IP 54
Insulation class ..................................................... F Insulation class ..................................................... F
,æ
,æ
,æ
,æ &æ &æ
ç&æ
ç&æ
ç3æ
,æçæ
æ
,æçæ
æ 6æ
ç3æ ç+æ ç+æ
ç3æ
0%æ æ
ç+æ ç+æ
ç+æ ç+æ
2UNNINGæ 2UNNINGæ
&æ
Xçæ Xçæ FORWARDæ REVERSEæ
0%æ
çæ çæ çæ çæ
çæ 5æ 6æ 7æ 0%æ
7æ -æ
6æ
æ
5æ
æ æ
178 31 309.1
Scavenge Air
14
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 14.01
Page of 1
Scavenge air is supplied to the engine by one or The scavenge air system (see Figs. 14.01.01 and
more turbochargers, located on the exhaust side 14.02.01) is an integrated part of the main engine.
of the engine. However, if the engine is fitted with
one turbocharger only, this can be located on the The engine power figures and the data in the list
aft end of the engine, option: 4 59 124. of capacities are based on MCR at tropical con-
ditions, i.e. a seawater temperature of 32 °C, or
The compressor of the turbocharger draws air freshwater temperature of 36 °C, and an ambient
from the engine room, through an air filter, and air inlet temperature of 45 °C.
the compressed air is cooled by the scavenge
air cooler, one per turbocharger. The scavenge
air cooler is provided with a water mist catcher,
which prevents condensate water from being car-
ried with the air into the scavenge air receiver and
to the combustion chamber.
%XHAUSTæGAS
RECEIVER
%XHAUSTæVALVE
4URBOCHARGER
#YLINDERæLINER
3CAVENGEæAIR
RECEIVER
3CAVENGEæAIR
COOLER
7ATERæMIST
CATCHER
178 25 188.1
Auxiliary Blowers
2UNNINGæWITHæAUXILIARYæBLOWER
2UNNINGæWITHæTURBOCHARGER
178 44 70-5.1
The auxiliary blowers are fitted onto the main en- • The Auxiliary Blower Starter Panels control and
gine and controlled by a system comprising: protect the Auxiliary Blowers, one panel with
starter per blower. The physical layout and
1 pc Control Panel choice of components has to be decided by the
1 pc Starter Panel per Auxiliary Blower manufacturer.
2 pc Pressure Switches
• The pressure switch ‘P’ controls the run/stop
Referring to the diagram of the auxiliary blower signals, while pressure switch ‘B’ is part of the
control system, Fig. 14.02.02: auxiliary blower alarm circuit.
• The Control Panel controls the run/stop signals The control panel is yard’s supply. It can be or-
to all Auxiliary Blower Starter Panels. The Con- dered as an option: 4 55 650.
trol Panel consists of an operation panel and a
terminal row interconnected by a 1,200 mm long The starter panels with starters for the auxiliary
wire harness. blower motors are not included, they can be
ordered as an option: 4 55 653. Heaters for the
blower motors are available as an option: 4 55 155.
#ONTROLæPANEL /NæENGINE
!LARMæSYSTEM
3AFETYæSYSTEM
%NGINEæ#ONTROLæ2OOMænæ%#2
%NGINEæROOM
- - - - -
!UXILIARY -OTOR !UXILIARY -OTOR !UXILIARY -OTOR !UXILIARY -OTOR !UXILIARY -OTOR
BLOWER HEATER BLOWER HEATER BLOWER HEATER BLOWER HEATER BLOWER HEATER
513 53 301.0.0
On the operation panel, three control modes are The operation panel and terminal row have to be
available to run/stop the blowers: mounted in the Engine Control Room Manoeu-
vring Console, see section 16.01.
• AUTO – Run/stop is automatically controlled by
scavenge air pressure The control panel for the auxiliary blowers includ-
ing the operation panel, wiring harness and termi-
• MANUAL – Start of all blowers in sequence at nal row is shown in Fig. 14.02.03.
intervals of 6 sec
-!).¬%.').%
!58),)!29¬",/7%2¬#/.42/,
AUXILIARY AUXILIARY AUXILIARY
BLOWER 1 BLOWER 2 BLOWER 3
RUNNING RUNNING RUNNING
+ + +
4ERMINALæROWæTOæBEæMOUNTEDæINæ
THEæ-ANOEUVRINGæ#ONSOLE
512 36 604.0.0
Fig. 14.02.03: Control panel including operation panel, wiring harness and terminal row, option: 4 55 650
æ4URBOCHARGER
4%ææææææ)
3CAVENGEæAIRæCOOLER 4)æææ 4%ææææææ)
4)æææ
3CAVENGEæAIRæCOOLER
%æææ %æææ
#YLæ
0)æææ
%XHAUSTæRECEIVER
121 36 89-5.2.0a
!IRæCOOLER
3CAVENGEæAIRæRECEIVER !UXILIARYæBLOWERS
#YLæ
!6
"6
178 50 591.1
The number of auxiliary blowers in a propulsion For typical engine configurations, the required
plant may vary depending on the actual amount of power of the auxiliary blowers as well as the in-
turbochargers as well as space requirements. stalled size of the electric motors are listed in Ta-
ble 14.04.01.
The installed power of the electric motors are based on a voltage supply of 3x440V at 60Hz.
The electric motors are delivered with and fitted onto the engine.
The air side of the scavenge air cooler can be Sludge is drained through ‘AL’ to the bilge tank
cleaned by injecting a grease dissolvent media and the polluted grease dissolvent returns from
through ‘AK’ to a spray pipe arrangement fitted to ‘AM’ through a filter, to the chemical cleaning
the air chamber above the air cooler element. tank. The cleaning must be carried out while the
engine is at standstill. The piping delivered with
and fitted on the engine is shown in Fig 14.05.01
‘Air cooler cleaning pipes’.
!+
7ATERæMISTæCATCHER
,3ææææææ!(
!, !-
!+
0)
$.æMM
!IRæCOOLER !IRæCOOLER
æ&RESHWATER
æFROMæHYDROPHOR !,
æ2ECIRCULATION
$.æMM
!-
$.æMM
4)
#IRCULATIONæ #HEMICAL
PUMP CLEANINGæTANK &ILTER $RAINæFROMæAIRæCOOLERæ
æMMæMESHæSIZE CLEANINGææWATERæMISTæ
CATCHERæINæAIRæCOOLER
(EATINGæCOIL
4OæFITæTHEæCHEMICAL æ3LUDGEæPUMPæSUCTION No. of cylinders
MAKERSæREQUIREMENT
5-6 7-9
Chemical tank capacity 0.3 m3 0.6 m3
Circulation pump capacity at 3 bar 1 m3/h 2 m3/h
The letters refer to list of ‘Counterflanges‘
079 61 05-4.1.0a
The scavenge air box is continuously drained Drain from water mist catcher
through ‘AV’ to a small pressurised drain tank,
from where the sludge is led to the sludge tank. The drain line for the air cooler system is, during
Steam can be applied through ‘BV’, if required, to running, used as a permanent drain from the air
facilitate the draining. See Fig. 14.06.01. cooler water mist catcher. The water is led through
an orifice to prevent major losses of scavenge air.
The continuous drain from the scavenge air box The system is equipped with a drain box with a
must not be directly connected to the sludge tank level switch, indicating any excessive water level.
owing to the scavenge air pressure. The pres-
surised drain tank must be designed to withstand The system delivered with and fitted on the engine
full scavenge air pressure and, if steam is applied, is shown in Fig. 14.03.02 Scavenge air space,
to withstand the steam pressure available. drain pipes.
$ECK2OOF
$.ææMM
-INæª
$.ææMM
.ORMALLYæOPEN
"6 !6 4OæBEæCLOSEDæINæCASEæOFæFIRE
INæTHEæSCAVENGEæAIRæBOX
/RIFICEææMM
-INæDISTANCE
æMM
3TEAMæINLETæPRESSUREæçæBAR $.ææMM
)FæSTEAMæISæNOTæAVAILABLEææBARæ
COMPRESSEDæAIRæCANæBEæUSED
$.ææMM
$RAIN
TANK
.ORMALLYæCLOSED
3LUDGEæTANK 4ANKæTOæBEæEMPTIED
FORæFUELæOIL DURINGæSERVICEæWITHæ
CENTRIFUGES VALVEæOPEN
No. of cylinders
5-6 7-9
Drain tank capacity 0.4 m3 0.7 m3
The letters refer to list of ‘Counterflanges’
079 61 03-0.2.0
Fire in the scavenge air space can be extinguished The key specifications of the fire extinguishing
by steam, this being the basic solution, or, option- agents are:
ally, by water mist or CO2.
Steam fire extinguishing for scavenge air space
The external system, pipe and flange connections Steam pressure: 310 bar
are shown in Fig. 14.07.01 and the piping fitted Steam quantity, approx.: 3.2 kg/cyl.
onto the engine in Fig. 14.07.02.
Water mist fire extinguishing for scavenge air space
In the Extent of Delivery, the fire extinguishing Freshwater pressure: min. 3.5 bar
system for scavenge air space is selected by the Freshwater quantity, approx.: 2.6 kg/cyl.
fire extinguishing agent:
CO2 fire extinguishing for scavenge air space
• basic solution: 4 55 140 Steam CO2 test pressure: 150 bar
• option: 4 55 142 Water mist CO2 quantity, approx.: 6.5 kg/cyl.
• option: 4 55 143 CO2
!4 !4
$.æMM
.ORMALæPOSITION
OPENæTOæBILGE $.æMM
#/ æBOTTLES
/PTIONæ7ATERæMISTæEXTINGUISHING #/ æ
&RESHæWATERæPRESSSUREæMINææBAR
!TæLEASTæTWOæBOTTLESæOUGHTæTOæBEæINSTALLED
)NæMOSTæCASESæONEæBOTTLEæSHOULDæBEæSUFFICIENTæ
TOæEXTINGUISHæFIREæINæTHREEæCYLILNDERSæWHILEæTWOæ
ORæMOREæBOTTLESæWOULDæBEæREQUIREDæTOæEXTINGUISHæ
!4 FIREæINæALLæCYLINDERS
$.æMM 4OæPREVENTæTHEæFIREæFROMæSPREADINGæTOæTHEæNEXT
CYLINDERS æTHEæBALLçVALVEæOFæTHEæNEIGHBOURING
.ORMALæPOSITION CYLINDERS æSHOULDæBEæOPENEDæINæTHEæEVENTæOF
OPENæTOæBILGE FIREæINæONEæCYLINDER
079 61 029.0.0a
%XHAUSTæSIDE
#YLæ
-ANOEUVERINGæSIDE
4%ææææææ)æææ!(æææ9 %XTINGUISHINGæAGENT
#/æ3TEAMæORæ&RESHWATER
!4
$RAINæPIPEæBEDPLATE
/NLYæFORæSTEAMæORæFRESHWATER
126 40 81-0.6.0a
Exhaust Gas
15
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 15.01
Page of 1
The exhaust gas is led from the cylinders to the Turbocharger arrangement and cleaning systems
exhaust gas receiver where the fluctuating pres-
sures from the cylinders are equalised and from The turbochargers are in the basic design, op-
where the gas is led further on to the turbocharger tion: 4 59 122, located on the exhaust side of the
at a constant pressure. See fig. 15.01.01. engine. However, if the engine is fitted with one
turbocharger only, it can be located on the aft end
Compensators are fitted between the exhaust of the engine, option: 4 59 124.
valve housings and the exhaust gas receiver and
between the receiver and the turbocharger. A pro- The engine is designed for the installation of the
tective grating is placed between the exhaust gas MAN Diesel turbocharger types TCA (4 59 101),
receiver and the turbocharger. The turbocharger ABB turbocharger type TPL (4 59 102), or MHI tur-
is fitted with a pickup for monitoring and remote bocharger type MET (4 59 103).
indication of the turbocharger speed.
All makes of turbochargers are fitted with an ar-
The exhaust gas receiver and the exhaust pipes rangement for water washing of the compressor
are provided with insulation, covered by steel side, and soft blast cleaning of the turbine side,
plating. see Figs. 15.02.02, 15.02.03 and 15.02.04. Wash-
ing of the turbine side is only applicable on MAN
Diesel and ABB turbochargers.
%XHAUSTæGAS
RECEIVER
%XHAUSTæVALVE
4URBOCHARGER
#YLINDERæLINER
3CAVENGEæAIR
RECEIVER
3CAVENGEæ
AIRæCOOLER
7ATERæMIST
CATCHER
178 07 274.1
4OæSCAVENGEæAIRæRECEIVER
4)æææ 0)æææ
0)æææ
%XHAUSTæGASæRECEIVER
4URBOCHARGER
4)æææ
4#ææææææ)æææ!(æææ9( 34ææææææ)
&LANGEæCONNECTIONæ$
æ !,æ$EVIATIONæALARM#YLINDERæ¢#
4)æææ æ 9,æ$EVIATIONæALARM#YLINDERæ¢#
Fig. 15.02.01a: Exhaust gas pipes, with turbocharger located on exhaust side of engine, option 4 59 122
4)æææ 4)æææ
4#ææææææ)æææ!(æææ!,æææ9(æææ9,
&LANGEæCONNECTIONæ$
%XHAUSTæGASæRECEIVER
4URBOCHARGER
0)æææ 4)æææ
0)æææ 4#ææææææ)æææ!(æææ9(
æ !,æ$EVIATIONæALARM#YLINDERæ¢#
4OæSCAVENGEæAIRæRECEIVER æ 9,æ$EVIATIONæALARM#YLINDERæ¢#
Fig.15.02.01b: Exhaust gas pipes, with turbocharger located on aft end of engine, option 4 59 124
Cleaning Systems
0)æææ
!.
#OMPRESSORæCLEANING
-!.æ$IESELæ4#!æTURBOCHARGER
4OæBEDPLATEæDRAINæ!%
121 15 21-8.0.0
Fig. 15.02.02: MAN Diesel TCA turbocharger, water washing of turbine side
Cleaning Systems
0)ææææ
!.
7ATERæINLET
)NLETæVALVE
!""æ40,æ4URBOCHARGER
$RAINæCOCK
#OMPRESSORæCLEANING
7ATERæCLEANINGæNOZZLE
4OæBEDPLATEæDRAINæ!%
121 36 75-1.0.0
Fig. 15.02.03: Water washing of turbine and compressor sides for ABB, TPL turbochargers
0)ææææ
!0
$RAIN
$RYæCLEANINGæTURBINEæSIDE
126 40 93-0.2.0
At the specified MCR of the engine, the total The exhaust system for the main engine com-
backpressure in the exhaust gas system after the prises:
turbocharger (as indicated by the static pressure
measured in the piping after the turbocharger) • Exhaust gas pipes
must not exceed 350 mm WC (0.035 bar). • Exhaust gas boiler
• Silencer
In order to have a backpressure margin for the • Spark arrester (if needed)
final system, it is recommended at the design • Expansion joints (compensators)
stage to initially use a value of about 300 mm WC • Pipe bracings.
(0.030 bar).
In connection with dimensioning the exhaust gas
The actual backpressure in the exhaust gas piping system, the following parameters must be
system at specified MCR depends on the gas observed:
velocity, i.e. it is proportional to the square of the
exhaust gas velocity, and hence inversely propor- • Exhaust gas flow rate
tional to the pipe diameter to the 4th power. It has • Exhaust gas temperature at turbocharger outlet
by now become normal practice in order to avoid • Maximum pressure drop through exhaust gas
too much pressure loss in the pipings to have an system
exhaust gas velocity at specified MCR of about • Maximum noise level at gas outlet to atmos-
35 m/sec, but not higher than 50 m/sec. phere
• Maximum force from exhaust piping on
For dimensioning of the external exhaust pipe turbocharger(s)
connections, see the exhaust pipe diameters for • Sufficient axial and lateral elongation ability of
35 m/sec, 40 m/sec, 45 m/sec and 50 m/sec re- expansion joints
spectively, shown in Table 15.07.02. • Utilisation of the heat energy of the exhaust gas.
As long as the total backpressure of the exhaust Items that are to be calculated or read from tables
gas system (incorporating all resistance losses are:
from pipes and components) complies with the
abovementioned requirements, the pressure • Exhaust gas mass flow rate, temperature and max-
losses across each component may be chosen in- imum back pressure at turbocharger gas outlet
dependently, see proposed measuring points (M) • Diameter of exhaust gas pipes
in Fig. 15.05.01. The general design guidelines for • Utilisation of the exhaust gas energy
each component, described below, can be used • Attenuation of noise from the exhaust pipe outlet
for guidance purposes at the initial project stage. • Pressure drop across the exhaust gas system
• Expansion joints.
$
%XHAUSTæGASæOUTLET $ %XHAUSTæGASæOUTLET
TOæTHEæATMOSPHERE TOæTHEæATMOSPHERE
%XHAUSTæGASæ
%XHAUSTæGASæ
SILENCER
SILENCER
$
$
3LIDEæSUPPORT %XHAUSTæGASæ
%XHAUSTæGASæ BOILER
3LIDEæSUPPORT BOILER
&IXEDæSUPPORT
&IXEDæSUPPORT $
$ %XHAUSTæGASæCOMPENSATOR
$
%XHAUSTæGASæCOMPENSATOR
4RANSITIONæPIECE
4URBOCHARGERæGAS
OUTLETæFLANGE $
-AINæENGINEæWITH
TURBOCHARGERæONæAFTæEND -AINæENGINEæWITHæTURBOCHARGERS
ONæEXHAUSTæSIDE
Fig. 15.04.01a: Exhaust gas system, one turbocharger Fig. 15.04.01b: Exhaust gas system, two or more TCs
When dimensioning the compensator (option: Engine plants are usually designed for utilisation of
4 60 610) for the expansion joint on the turbochar- the heat energy of the exhaust gas for steam pro-
ger gas outlet transition piece (option: 4 60 601) duction or for heating the thermal oil system. The
the exhaust gas piece and components, are to be exhaust gas passes an exhaust gas boiler which is
so arranged that the thermal expansions are ab- usually placed near the engine top or in the funnel.
sorbed by expansion joints. The heat expansion of
the pipes and the components is to be calculated It should be noted that the exhaust gas tempera-
based on a temperature increase from 20 °C to ture and flow rate are influenced by the ambient
250 °C. The max. expected vertical, transversal conditions, for which reason this should be con-
and longitudinal heat expansion of the engine sidered when the exhaust gas boiler is planned. At
measured at the top of the exhaust gas transition specified MCR, the maximum recommended pres-
piece of the turbocharger outlet are indicated in sure loss across the exhaust gas boiler is normally
Fig. 15.06.01 and Table 15.06.02 as DA, DB and DC. 150 mm WC.
The movements stated are related to the engine This pressure loss depends on the pressure losses
seating, for DC, however, to the engine centre. The in the rest of the system as mentioned above.
figures indicate the axial and the lateral movements Therefore, if an exhaust gas silencer/spark ar-
related to the orientation of the expansion joints. rester is not installed, the acceptable pressure loss
across the boiler may be somewhat higher than the
The expansion joints are to be chosen with an elas- max. of 150 mm WC, whereas, if an exhaust gas
ticity that limits the forces and the moments of the silencer/spark arrester is installed, it may be neces-
exhaust gas outlet flange of the turbocharger as sary to reduce the maximum pressure loss.
stated for each of the turbocharger makers in Table
15.06.04. The orientation of the maximum permis- The above mentioned pressure loss across the
sible forces and moments on the gas outlet flange exhaust gas boiler must include the pressure
of the turbocharger is shown in Fig. 15.06.03. losses from the inlet and outlet transition pieces.
The exhaust gas back pressure after the turbo Exhaust gas velocity (v)
charger(s) depends on the total pressure drop in
the exhaust gas piping system. In a pipe with diameter D the exhaust gas velocity is:
v = __
M _____4
ρ x π x D 2
in m/s
The components, exhaust gas boiler, silencer, and
spark arrester, if fitted, usually contribute with a Pressure losses in pipes (∆p)
major part of the dynamic pressure drop through
the entire exhaust gas piping system. For a pipe element, like a bend etc., with the resist-
ance coefficient ζ, the corresponding pressure
The components mentioned are to be specified loss is:
so that the sum of the dynamic pressure drop
through the different components should, if pos- ∆p = ζ x ½ ρ v2 x ___1
9.81 in mm WC
sible, approach 200 mm WC at an exhaust gas
flow volume corresponding to the specified MCR where the expression after ζ is the dynamic pres-
at tropical ambient conditions. Then there will be sure of the flow in the pipe.
a pressure drop of 100 mm WC for distribution
among the remaining piping system. The friction losses in the straight pipes may, as a
guidance, be estimated as :
Fig. 15.05.01 shows some guidelines regarding
resistance coefficients and backpressure loss 1 mm WC per 1 diameter length
calculations which can be used, if the maker’s
data for backpressure is not available at an early whereas the positive influence of the updraught
stage of the project. in the vertical pipe is normally negligible.
Mass density of exhaust gas (ρ) where ∆p incorporates all pipe elements and
components etc. as described:
ρ ≅ 1.293 x ______
273
273
+T
x 1.015 in kg/m3
∆pM has to be lower than 350 mm WC.
The factor 1.015 refers to the average backpres-
sure of 150 mm WC (0.015 bar) in the exhaust gas (At design stage it is recommended to use max.
system. 300 mm WC in order to have some margin for
fouling).
a a
60 b
Changeover valves 90 R = D ζ = 0.28
90 R = 1.5D ζ = 0.20
c Changeover valve D
R = 2D ζ = 0.17
of type with con- R
stant cross section
ζa = 0.6 to 1.2
60
20 ζb = 1.0 to 1.5 R = D ζ = 0.16
a b
ζc = 1.5 to 2.0 R = 1.5D ζ = 0.12
D
R
R = 2D ζ = 0.11
Changeover valve
of type with volume
ζa = ζb = about 2.0 30
ζ = 0.05
D
M
90
p Spark
arrester D
M
R = D ζ = 0.45
R
R = 1.5D ζ = 0.35
R = 2D ζ = 0.30
p2 Silencer
45
ptc
M
D
M ζ = 0.14
Exhaust
p3 gas boiler
M
Outlet from ζ = 1.00
top of exhaust
gas uptake
Mtc Mtc
Inlet (from
T/C turbocharger) ζ = – 1.00
M: Measuring points
178 32 091.0 178 06 853.0
$"
$"
$#
Fig. 15.06.01a: Vectors of thermal expansion at the turbocharger exhaust gas outlet flange, TC on exhaust side
Table 15.06.02a: Max. expected movements of the exhaust gas flange resulting from thermal expansion, TC on exhaust side
$!
!FT #YLæ
$#
DA: Max. movement of the turbocharger flange in the vertical direction 078 87 11-1.0.0a
DC: Max. movement of the turbocharger flange in the longitudinal direction
Fig. 15.06.01b: Vectors of thermal expansion at the turbocharger exhaust gas outlet flange, TC on aft end
Table 15.06.02b: Max. expected movements of the exhaust gas flange resulting from thermal expansion, TC on aft end
-!.æ$IESEL !""æ40,
& &
- - - -
-ITSUBISHI
& - -
& &
078 38 48-6.2.0
Fig. 15.06.03: Forces and moments on the turbochargers’ exhaust gas outlet flange
Table 15.06.04 indicates the maximum permis- M3), on the exhaust gas outlet flange of the turbo-
sible forces (F1, F2 and F3) and moments (M1 and charger(s). Reference is made to Fig. 15.06.03.
Turbocharger M1 M3 F1 F2 F3
Make Type Nm Nm N N N
TCA55 3,400 6,900 9,100 9,100 4,500
TCA66 3,700 7,500 9,900 9,900 4,900
TCA77 4,100 8,200 10,900 10,900 5,400
MAN Diesel TCA88 4,500 9,100 12,000 12,000 5,900
NA48 3,600 2,400 6,000 6,000 2,400
NA57 4,300 3,000 7,000 7,000 3,000
NA70 5,300 3,500 8,800 8,800 3,500
TPL73 5,500 5,500 9,500 9,000 9,000
ABB TPL77 7,700 7,700 11,500 10,000 10,000
TPL80 11,000 11,000 15,000 13,000 13,000
MET53 4,900 2,500 7,300 2,600 2,300
MHI MET66 6,800 3,400 9,300 3,200 3,000
MET83 9,800 4,900 11,700 4,100 3,700
Table 15.06.04: The max. permissible forces and moments on the turbocharger’s gas outlet flanges
The exhaust gas pipe diameters listed in Table The exhaust gas velocities and mass flow listed
15.07.02 are based on the exhaust gas flow ca- apply to collector pipe D4. The table also lists the
pacity according to ISO ambient conditions and diameters of the corresponding exhaust gas pipes
an exhaust gas temperature of 250 ºC. D0 for various numbers of turbochargers installed.
%XPANSIONæJOINT
OPTIONæææ
$ $
$ $
$
&IXEDæPOINT
$
%XPANSIONæJOINT
OPTIONæææ
4RANSITIONæPIECE 4RANSITIONæPIECE
OPTIONæææ OPTIONæææ
#ENTREæLINEæTURBOCHARGER #ENTREæLINEæTURBOCHARGER
Fig. 15.07.01a: Exhaust pipe system, with turbocharger Fig. 15.07.01b: Exhaust pipe system, with single turbo-
located on exhaust side of engine, option: 4 59 122 charger located on aft end of engine, option: 4 59 124
Table 15.07.02: Exhaust gas pipe diameters and exhaust gas mass flow at various velocities
16
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 16.01
Page of 12
)Næ%NGINEæ#ONTROLæ2OOM
%#2æPANEL
)Næ%NGINEæ2OOM/Næ%NGINE
%3# 'OVERNOR
0RESSUREæTRANSMITTERæFORæSCAVENGEæAIR !CTUATORæFORæFUELæPUMP
20-æPICKçUPS
178 58 06-8.0
317 74 06-9.0.0
Fig. 16.01.02a: Diagram of manoeuvring system for reversible engine with FPP, slow turning and VIT
(Basic for S/K98-80MC/MC-C, optional on S/L70-60 & S50MC-C)
317 72 03-2.2.0
Fig. 16.01.02b: Diagram of manoeuvring system for reversible engine with FPP and slow turning, no VIT
(Basic for S/L70-60 & 35MC/MC-C as well as S50-26MC/MC-C)
The basic manoeuvring diagram is applicable for The slow turning valve diverts the starting air to
reversible engines, i.e. those with Fixed Pitch Pro- partially bypass the main starting valve. During
peller (FPP), and shown in Fig. 16.01.02a and b. slow turning the engine will rotate so slowly that,
In the event that liquids have accumulated on the
The lever on the Engine Side Console can be set piston top, the engine will stop before any harm
to either Manual or Remote position, see Fig. occurs.
16.01.06a, b and c.
Sequenc g a
B C e b B a po b
of 12
:3 #
3ERVICEææ"LOCKED
:3 #
!
:3 #
-AINæSTARTINGæVALVE
:3 #
3LOWæTURNING
VALVE
8
8
:6 # 3LOWæTURNING
3TARTINGæAIR
DISTRIBUTOR
3TARTINGæVALVE
%NGINEæCONTROL
28 1 3/4-way solenoid valve
ROOMæCONSOLE
78 1 Switch, yard’s supply
Additional components for slow turning are the slow turning valve in bypass and position nos. 28 and 78
The item No. refers to ‘Guidance values ‘automation’
The letter refers to list of ‘Counterflanges’
The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine
178 58 11.5-0
Fig. 16.01.03: Starting air system, with slow turning, option: 4 50 140
The engine is, as standard, provided with an elec- Governor for ‘Conventional’ plants
tronic/mechanical type of fuel pump actuator of a
make approved by MAN Diesel. A typical example of a ‘conventional’ marine in-
stallation is:
The speed setting of the actuator is determined by
an electronic signal from the electronic governor • An engine directly coupled to a fixed pitch pro-
of a make approved by MAN Diesel. The actuator peller.
shaft is connected to the fuel regulating shaft by
means of a mechanical linkage. With a view to such an installations, the engine is,
as standard, equipped with a ‘conventional’ elec-
When selecting the governor, the complexity of tronic governor with actuator of a make approved
the installation has to be considered. We normally by MAN Diesel, e.g.:
distinguish between ‘conventional’ and ‘advanced’
marine installations. 4 65 170 Woodward
The governor consists of the following elements: 4 65 172 Lyngsø Marine A/S
The minimum speed is 20-25% of the engines The electronic governors have to be tailor-made,
nominal speed when an electronic governor is ap- and the specific layout of the system has to be
plied. mutually agreed upon by the customer, the gover-
nor supplier and the engine builder.
UAL
-AN OL
TR
CON
R
ERNO
' OV O L
N T R
CO
R ACK
&UELæ
:3 #
!CTUATORæFORæFUELæRACK
% # %NGINEæSIDEæHANDWHEEL
178 58 12-7.0
2EMOTE
-ANUAL
-).
34!24
-!8
34/0
4ELEGRAPH
#ONTROLæROOM
!HEAD !STERN
"RIDGEæCONTROL
!STERN
!HEAD
3TART
3TOP
:3ææ#
:3æ
:3æ
03ææ#
:3ææ#
:3ææ#
:3ææ#
:3ææ#
:3ææ#
:3ææ#
178 58 13-9.0
Fig. 16.01.05: Components for remote control of reversible engine with FPP with bridge control
2%-/4%
-!.5!,
-!8
!34%2.
34!24
!(%!$
-).
34!24 34/0
34/0
34/0
178 58 15-2.0
2%-/4%
!(%!$
-!.5!,
03 #
æ
6)4
03 # æ!HEAD
æ!STERN
3UPPLY
ææ3TOP
03 #
ææ3TART
ææ2EMOTE
æ4ERMINALææONLYæCONNECTEDæONæENGINESæWITHæ6)4æTYPEæFUELæPUMPS
178 58 16-4.0
34!24
34/0
34/0
-!8
-).
2%-æææææ% %-%2'%.#9 !(æææææ$ !34%2.
34!24
34/0
Components included for: The instrument panel includes:
178 58 14-0.0
178 58 17-6.0
1 Free space for mounting of safety panel 8 Switch and lamp for cancelling of limiters for
Engine builder’s supply governor
2 Tachometer(s) for turbocharger(s) 9 Engine control handle, option: 4 65 625 from engine
3 Indication lamps for: maker
Ahead * 10 Pressure gauges for:
Astern Scavenge air
Engine Side Control Lubricating oil, main engine
Control Room Control Cooling oil, main engine
Wrong way alarm Jacket cooling water
Turning gear engaged Sea cooling water
Main starting valve in service Lubricating oil, camshaft
Main starting valve in blocked mode Fuel oil before filter
Remote control Fuel oil after filter
Shut down Starting air
(Spare) Control air supply
Lamp test * 10 Thermometer:
4 Tachometer for main engine Jacket cooling water
5 Revolution counter Lubricating oil water
6 Switch and lamps for auxiliary blowers
7 Free spares for mounting of bridge control
equipment for main engine
Note: If an axial vibration monitor is ordered (option: 4 * These instruments have to be ordered as option:
31 116 ) the manoeuvring console has to be extended 4 75 645 and the corresponding analogue sensors on
by a remote alarm/slow down indication lamp. the engine as option: 4 75 128.
Fig. 16.01.07: Instruments and pneumatic components for Engine Control Room console, yard’s supply
178 58 22-3.0
Fig. 16.01.08a: Sequence diagram for fixed pitch propeller, MC/MC-C types 98-60
Alarm system
Remote Control system
The alarm system has no direct effect on the En
gine Control System (ECS). The alarm alerts the The remote control system normally has two alter
operator of an abnormal condition. native control stations:
Engine monitoring
• cylinder pressure
• fuel oil injection pressure
• scavenge air pressure
• engine speed.
Instrumentation
Vibration Aspects
17
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 17.01
Page of 1
C C
Vibration Aspects
The vibration characteristics of the twostroke low A
speed diesel engines can for practical purposes
be split up into four categories, and if the adequate
countermeasures are considered from the early
project stage, the influence of the excitation sour
ces can be minimised or fully compensated. B
300
50MC
250
60MC 5n
od
70MC
200 e
80MC
90MC 150
4 no
de
100
3 nod
e
50
2 node
dwt
178 06 924.1
Fig. 17.02.01: Statistics of vertical hull vibrations in tankers and bulk carriers
The 2nd order moment acts only in the vertical 1) No compensators, if considered unnecessary
direction. Precautions need only to be considered on the basis of natural frequency, nodal point
for 5 and 6-cylinder engines in general. and size of the 2nd order moment.
Resonance with the 2nd order moment may oc- 2) A compensator mounted on the aft end of the
cur in the event of hull vibrations with more than engine, driven by the main chain drive, option:
3 nodes. Contrary to the calculation of natural 4 31 203 (types 46 and larger).
frequency with 2 and 3 nodes, the calculation of
the 4 and 5-node natural frequencies for the hull 3) A compensator mounted on the fore end,
is a rather comprehensive procedure and often driven from the crankshaft through a separate
not very accurate, despite advanced calculation chain drive, options: 4 31 213 (types 46 and
methods. larger)
A 2nd order moment compensator comprises two 4) Compensators on both aft and fore ends,
counterrotating masses running at twice the en- driven from the crankshaft by the main chain
gine speed. 2nd order moment compensators are drive and a separate chain drive respectively,
not included in the basic extent of delivery. options 4 31 203 and 4 31 213.
Several solutions are available to cope with the As standard, the compensators reduce the exter-
2nd order moment, as shown in Fig. 17.03.02, out nal 2nd order moment to a level as for a 7-cylinder
of which the most cost efficient one can be cho- engine or less.
sen in the individual case, e.g.:
If it is decided not to use chain driven moment The decision whether or not to install compen-
compensators and, furthermore, not to prepare sators can be taken at a much later stage of a
the main engine for compensators to be fitted project, since no special version of the engine
later, another solution can be used, if annoying structure has to be ordered for the installation.
vibrations should occur: An electrically driven
moment compensator synchronised to the cor- No preparation for a later installation nor an ex-
rect phase relative to the external force or mo- tra chain drive for the compensator on the fore
ment can neutralise the excitation. end of the engine is required. This saves the
cost of such preparation, often left unused.
This type of compensator needs an extra seating
fitted, preferably, in the steering gear room where Compensators could be retrofit, even on ships
vibratory deflections are largest and the effect of in service, and also be applied to engines with
the compensator will therefore be greatest. a higher number of cylinders than is normally
considered relevant, if found necessary.
The electrically driven compensator will not give
rise to distorting stresses in the hull, but it is more The compensator only needs to be active at
expensive than the engine-mounted compensa- speeds critical for the hull girder vibration.
tors 2), 3) and 4). It does, however, offer several Thus, it may be activated or deactivated at
advantages over the engine mounted solutions: specified speeds automatically or manually.
When placed in the steering gear room, the Combinations with and without moment com-
compensator is not as sensitive to the position- pensators are not required in torsional and ax-
ing of the node as the compensators 2) and 3). ial vibration calculations, since the electrically
driven moment compensator is not part of the
mass-elastic system of the crankshaft.
178 57 45-6.0
Fig. 17.03.01: MAN B&W 1st or 2nd order electrically driven moment compensator, separately mounted,
option: 4 31 605.
-OMENTæCOMPENSATOR #OMPENSATINGæMOMENT
!FTæENDæOPTIONæææ &#æXæ,NODE
OUTBALANCESæ-6
-6
.ODEæ!&4
&#
,NODE
-OMENTæFROMæCOMPENSATOR
-#æREDUCESæ-6
-OMENTæCOMPENSATOR
&OREæENDæOPTIONæææ -6
-#
%LECTRICæDRIVENæMOMENTæCOMPENSATOR
#OMPENSATINGæMOMENT
&$æXæ,NODE
OUTBALANCESæ-6
#ENTREæLINE
CRANKSHAFT -6
&$
.ODEæ!FT
æANDæçNODEæVERTICALæHULLæGIRDERæMODE
, N
$ OD
æ.ODE E
æ.ODE
178 27 104.1
Fig. 17.03.02: Compensation of 2nd order vertical external moments
To evaluate if there is a risk that 1st and 2nd or- Based on service experience from a great number
der external moments will excite disturbing hull of large ships with engines of different types and
vibrations, the concept Power Related Unbal- cylinder numbers, the PRUvalues have been
ance (PRU) can be used as a guidance, see Table classified in four groups as follows:
17.04.01 below.
PRU Nm/kW Need for compensator
___________
PRU = External moment
Nm/kW 0 - 60 Not relevant
Engine power
60 - 120 Unlikely
With the PRUvalue, stating the external moment 120 - 220 Likely
relative to the engine power, it is possible to give 220 - Most likely
an estimate of the risk of hull vibrations for a spe-
cific engine.
{ }
nA 2
MA = M1 x __
n kNm
1
4OPæBRACINGæLEVEL
-IDDLEæPOSITIONæOFæGUIDEæPLANE
,Z ,Z $IST8
-(
, , #YL8 -X
#RANKSHAFTæCENTREæLINE
,X ,X %NGINEæSEATINGæLEVEL
: 8
178 06 816.3
The socalled guide force moments are caused We recommend using the hydraulic top bracing
by the transverse reaction forces acting on the which allow adjustment to the loading conditions
crossheads due to the connecting rod/cranskahft of the ship. Mechanical top bracings with stiff
mechanism. These moments may excite engine connections are available on request.
vibrations, moving the engine top athwartships
and causing a rocking (excited by Hmoment) or With both types of top bracing abovementioned
twisting (excited by Xmoment) movement of the natural frequency will increase to a level where res-
engine as illustrated in the above figure. onance will occur above the normal engine speed.
Details of the top bracings are shown in Chapter 05.
The guide force moments corresponding to the
MCR rating (L1) are stated in Table 17.07.01. Definition of Guide Force Moments
Top bracing Over the years it has been discussed how to de-
fine the guide force moments. Especially now that
The guide force moments are harmless except complete FEMmodels are made to predict hull/
when resonance vibrations occur in the engine/ engine interaction, the propeller definition of these
double bottom system. moments has become increasingly important.
As this system is very difficult to calculate with the Htype Guide Force Moment (MH)
necessary accuracy MAN Diesel strongly recom-
mend, as standard, that top bracing is installed Each cylinder unit produces a force couple con-
between the engine’s upper platform brackets sisting of:
and the casing side.
1. A force at crankshaft level.
The vibration level on the engine when installed in
the vessel must comply with MAN Diesel vibration 2. Another force at crosshead guide level. The
units as stated in Fig. 17.05.02. position of the force changes over one revo-
lution as the guide shoe reciprocates on the
guide.
,IMITS¬VALID¬FOR¬SINGLE¬ORDER¬HARMONICS
M
æM
M
æ
XææMMS
)))
æ æ
M
M
S
ææææMMS
M
æM
æ ç
¢MMS
T
EN
EM
))
¢
AC
M
PL
S
IS
M
$
M
¢
¢MMS
M
M
¢
6ELOCITY ) æ æ
M
M
S
æMMS
M
æM
æ ç
!C
CE
LE
RA
TIO
N¬
æ æ
M
M
S
æMMS
M
æM
æç
XæçæMMS
æCMIN
æM æ æ
M M
S M
S
:ONEææ !CCEPTABLE
:ONEææ 6IBRATIONæWILLæNOTæDAMAGEæTHEæMAINæENGINEæHOWEVER
æ UNDERæADVERSEæCONDITIONSæANNOYINGHARMFULæVIBRATION
æ RESPONSESæMAYæAPPEARæINæTHEæCONNECTEDæSTRUCTURES
:ONEææ .OTæACCEPTABLE
078 81 27-6.0
As the deflection shape for the Htype is equal The Xtype guide force moment is then defined
for each cylinder the Nth order Htype guide force as:
moment for an Ncylinder engine with regular fir-
ing order is: MX = ‘BiMoment’/L [kNm]
N x MH(one cylinder) For modelling purpose the size of the four (4) forc-
es can be calculated:
For modelling purposes the size of the forces in
the force couple is: Force = MX /L X [kN]
where L is the distance between crankshaft level L X is the horizontal length between ‘force points’
and the middle position of the crosshead guide
(i.e. the length of the connecting rod.) Similar to the situation for the Htype guide force
moment, the forces may be applied in positions
As the interaction between engine and hull is at suitable for the FEM model of the hull. Thus the
the engine seating and the top bracing positions, forces may be referred to another vertical level L Z
this force couple may alternatively be applied in above crankshaft centre line. These forces can be
those positions with a vertical distance of (L Z). calculated as follows:
Then the force can be calculated as:
M xL
ForceZ = MH/L Z [kN] ForceZ, one point = _____
Lxx L
[kN]
Axial Vibrations
When the crank throw is loaded by the gas pres- The socalled QPT (Quick Passage of a barred
sure through the connecting rod mechanism, the speed range Technique), is an alternative to a
arms of the crank throw deflect in the axial direction torsional vibration damper, on a plant equipped
of the crankshaft, exciting axial vibrations. Through with a controllable pitch propeller. The QPT could
the thrust bearing, the system is connected to the be implemented in the governor in order to limit
ship’s hull. the vibratory stresses during the passage of the
barred speed range.
Generally, only zeronode axial vibrations are of
interest. Thus the effect of the additional bending The application of the QPT, option: 4 31 108, has to
stresses in the crankshaft and possible vibrations be decided by the engine maker and MAN Diesel
of the ship`s structure due to the reaction force in based on final torsional vibration calculations.
the thrust bearing are to be considered.
Sixcylinder engines, require special attention.
An axial damper is fitted as standard on all engines, On account of the heavy excitation, the natural
minimising the effects of the axial vibrations (4 31 111). frequency of the system with one-node vibration
should be situated away from the normal operat-
ing speed range, to avoid its effect. This can be
Torsional Vibrations achieved by changing the masses and/or the stiff-
ness of the system so as to give a much higher, or
The reciprocating and rotating masses of the en- much lower, natural frequency, called undercritical
gine including the crankshaft, the thrust shaft, the or overcritical running, respectively.
intermediate shaft(s), the propeller shaft and the
propeller are for calculation purposes considered Owing to the very large variety of possible shaft-
as a system of rotating masses (inertias) intercon- ing arrangements that may be used in combina-
nected by torsional springs. The gas pressure of tion with a specific engine, only detailed torsional
the engine acts through the connecting rod mech- vibration calculations of the specific plant can
anism with a varying torque on each crank throw, determine whether or not a torsional vibration
exciting torsional vibration in the system with dif- damper is necessary.
ferent frequencies.
Undercritical running
In general, only torsional vibrations with one and
two nodes need to be considered. The main The natural frequency of the one-node vibration
critical order, causing the largest extra stresses is so adjusted that resonance with the main criti-
in the shaft line, is normally the vibration with cal order occurs about 3545% above the engine
order equal to the number of cylinders, i.e., six speed at specified MCR.
cycles per revolution on a six cylinder engine.
This resonance is positioned at the engine speed Such undercritical conditions can be realised by
corresponding to the natural torsional frequency choosing a rigid shaft system, leading to a rela-
divided by the number of cylinders. tively high natural frequency.
The torsional vibration conditions may, for certain The characteristics of an undercritical system are
installations require a torsional vibration damper, normally:
option: 4 31 105. • Relatively short shafting system
• Probably no tuning wheel
Based on our statistics, this need may arise for • Turning wheel with relatively low inertia
the following types of installation: • Large diameters of shafting, enabling the use of
• Plants with controllable pitch propeller shafting material with a moderate ultimate ten-
• Plants with unusual shafting layout and for spe- sile strength, but requiring careful shaft align-
cial owner/yard requirements ment, (due to relatively high bending stiffness)
• Plants with 8cylinder engines. • Without barred speed range
Critical Running
When running undercritical, significant varying Torsional vibrations in overcritical conditions may,
torque at MCR conditions of about 100150% of in special cases, have to be eliminated by the use
the mean torque is to be expected. of a torsional vibration damper.
This torque (propeller torsional amplitude) induces Overcritical layout is normally applied for engines
a significant varying propeller thrust which, under with more than four cylinders.
adverse conditions, might excite annoying longi-
tudinal vibrations on engine/double bottom and/or Please note:
deck house. We do not include any tuning wheel or torsional
vibration damper in the standard scope of supply,
The yard should be aware of this and ensure that as the proper countermeasure has to be found af-
the complete aft body structure of the ship, in- ter torsional vibration calculations for the specific
cluding the double bottom in the engine room, is plant, and after the decision has been taken if and
designed to be able to cope with the described where a barred speed range might be acceptable.
phenomena.
For further information about vibration aspects,
please refer to our publications:
Overcritical running
An Introduction to Vibration Aspects
The natural frequency of the onenode vibration
is so adjusted that resonance with the main criti- Vibration Characteristics of Two-stroke Engines
cal order occurs about 3070% below the engine
speed at specified MCR. Such overcritical con- The publications are available at
ditions can be realised by choosing an elastic www.mandiesel.com under
shaft system, leading to a relatively low natural ‘Quicklinks’ → ‘Technical Papers’
frequency.
No of cylinder : 5 6 7 8 9
1-9-2-5-7-3-6-
Firing type : 1-4-3-2-5 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6
4-8
a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.
c) 5 and 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the
2nd order external moment.
Table 17.07.01
18
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 18.01
Page of 1
• CoCoS system
type EDS online, option: 4 09 660
PMI System
0RESSUREæTRANSDUCER
0-)æCONTOLLERæBOX
*UNCTIONæBOX
)NDICATORæCOCK
#YLINDERæCOVER
æ3UPPLY
æ6æ$#æM!
0RINTER
)NTERMEDIATEæBOX
0#
/THERæEQUIPMENT
23 23 &ORE
"RACKETæMOUNTINGæOFæENCODER
!NGLEæENCODER
#ONVERTERæBOX
#/.42/,æ2//- %.').%æ2//-
æ#ABLEæDELIVEREDæBYæ9ARD
178 59 57-7.0
The PMI system is available in two versions, • On-line version, option 4 75 215:
PT/S off-line and on-line, see Fig. 18.02.01 and 02. Fixed mounted pressure transducing sensor on
each cylinder for continuous measurements,
The basic functions of the two different versions analysis and adjustments.
are:
PMI PMI
MasterUnit Slave Unit
Scavenge Air 24V DC
Pressure Sensor Power Supply
Trigger Pulses
SC1 from Crank Angle
Pickup, Angle
Calibration Box Encoder, etc.
CJB
with 8m cable
CA7 Abbreviations:
CA: Charge Amplifier
SC: Signal Conditioner
Cyl.7 Cyl: Engine Cylinder Sensor
CJB: Calibration Junction Box
178 51 477.1
CoCoS-EDS
General data
SE 8801 Turbocharger speed T/C
PE 8802 Ambient pressure 1 900 1100 mbar Absolute !
SE 4020 Engine speed 1
ZE 3003 Governor index (absolute) 1
Power take off/in from main engine shaft 1 With option
(PTO/PTI) installed
XC1401 Mean Indicated Pressure MIP Cyl. 1)
XC1402 Maximum Pressure Pmax Cyl. 1)
XC1403 Compression Pressure Pcomp Cyl. 1)
– PMI online engine speed Cyl. rpm 1)
1): In case of MAN Diesel PMI system signal from PMI system. Other MIP systems signal from manual input
The shut down system must be electrically sepa- Alarm, slow down and remote indication sensors
rated from other systems by using independent
sensors, or sensors common for the alarm system The International Association of Classification So-
but with galvanically separated electrical circuits, cieties (IACS) indicates that a common sensor can
i.e. one sensor with two sets of electrically inde- be used for alarm, slow down and remote indica-
pendent terminals. The list of sensors are shown tion.
in Table 18.04.04.
A general view of the alarm, slow down and shut
down systems is shown in Fig. 18.04.01.
Attended Machinery Space (AMS)
Tables 18.04.02 and 18.04.03 show the require-
The basic safety system for a MAN Diesel engine ments by MAN Diesel for alarm and slow down
is designed for Attended Machinery Space and and for UMS by the classification societies (Class),
comprises the temperature sensors and pressure as well as IACS’ recommendations.
sensors that are specified in the ‘MAN Diesel’ col-
umn for shut down in Table 18.04.04. The number of sensors to be applied to a specific
plant for UMS is the sum of requirements of the
These sensors are included in the basic scope of classification society, the Buyer and MAN Diesel.
supply (option: 4 75 124) and are also included for
UMS. If further analogue sensors are required, they can
be ordered as option: 4 75 128.
Unattended Machinery Space (UMS) The slow down functions are designed to safe-
guard the engine components against overloading
In the ‘Extent of Delivery’ an asterisk (*) marks during normal service conditions and to keep the
items normally required for plants designed for ship manoeuvrable if fault conditions occur.
UMS including the sensors for alarm and slow
down, option: 4 75 127, but not those for shut The slow down sequence must be adapted to the
down. actual plant parameters, such as for FPP or CPP,
engine with or without shaft generator, and to the
The shut down and slow down panels can be or- required operating mode.
dered as options: 4 75 610, 4 75 614 or 4 75 615
whereas the alarm panel is yard’s supply, as it
normally includes several other alarms than those
for the main engine.
The figure shows the concept approved by all One common power supply might be used, in-
classification societies. stead of the three indicated, provided that the
systems are equipped with separate fuses.
The shut down panel and slow down panel can be
combined for some makers.
2EQUIREDæBY
2EMOTE "INARYæSENSOR CLASSIFICATIONæ
INDICATION SOCIETYæAND
-!.æ$IESEL
!NALOGæSENSOR
OPTIONæææ
!DDITIONALæSENSORS
"INARYæSENSOR OPTION
ææ
!NALOGæSENSOR OR
ææ
/UTPUTæSIGNALS
3HUTæDOWN
0OWERæSUPPLYæ PANEL
"INARYæSENSORS
)NCLUDEDæIN
OPTIONæææ
!NALOGæSENSORS
0OWERæSUPPLYæ
178 30 100.5
Fig. 18.04.01: Panels and sensors for alarm and safety systems
MAN Diesel
RINA
IACS
Sensor and
CCS
DNV
ABS
NK
KR
RS
GL
BV
LR
Lubricating oil
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PT 8103 AL Lubricating oil inlet to turbocharger/turbocharger
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 TE 8106 AH Thrust bearing segment
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PT 8108 AL Lubricating oil inlet to main engine
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 TE 8112 AH Lubricating oil inlet to main engine
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 TE 8113 AH Piston cooling oil outlet/cylinder
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 FS 8114 AL Piston cooling oil outlet/cylinder
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 TE 8117 AH Turbocharger lubricating oil outlet from
1
turbocharger/turbocharger 2)
1 TE 8123 AH Main bearing oil outlet temperature/main bearing
(Only MC types 42-26)
1 XC 8126 AH Bearing wear (K98MC6/7 and all MC-C)
Water in lubricating oil (All MC/MC-C except S80-
1 XS 8150 AH
50MC6)
Water in lubricating oil – too high (All MC/MC-C except
1 XS 8150 AH
S80-50MC6)
MAN Diesel
RINA
IACS
Sensor and
CCS
DNV
ABS
NK
KR
RS
GL
BV
LR
Compressed air
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PT 8501 AL Starting air inlet to main starting valve
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1+ 1 1 1 PT 8503 AL Control air inlet and finished with engine
1 1 PT 8505 AL Air inlet to air cylinder for exhaust valve
Scavenge air
1 1 1 PS 8604 AL Scavenge air, auxiliary blower, failure
1 1 1 1÷ 1 TE 8609 AH Scavenge air receiver
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 TE 8610 AH Scavenge air box – fire alarm, cylinder/cylinder
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 LS 8611 AH Water mist catcher – water level
MAN Diesel
RINA
IACS
Sensor and
CCS
DNV
ABS
NK
KR
RS
GL
BV
LR
Miscellaneous
1 ZT 8801 AH Turbocharger overspeed
1 WT 8805 AH Vibration of turbocharger
1 WT 8812 AH Axial vibration monitor 2)
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 XS 8813 AH Oil mist in crankcase/cylinder
1 1 XS 8814 AL Oil mist detector failure
1 XC 8816 I Shaftline earthing device
(1) May be combined with TC 8702 AH where turbocharger is mounted directly on the exhaust manifold.
Alarm for overheating of main, crank and crosshead bearings, option: 4 75 134.
MAN Diesel
RINA
IACS
Sensor and
CCS
DNV
ABS
NK
KR
RS
GL
BV
LR
Or alarm for overheating of main, crank and crosshead bearings, option: 4 75 134.
See also Table 18.04.04: Shut down functions for AMS and UMS
Shut down for AMS and UMS – Class and MAN Diesel requirements
MAN Diesel
RINA
IACS
Sensor and
CCS
DNV
ABS
NK
KR
RS
GL
BV
LR
Or alarm for overheating of main, crank and crosshead bearings, option: 4 75 134.
See also Table 18.04.03: Slow down functions for UMS
* Or slow down
The members of the International Association of Classification Societies, IACS, have agreed that the stated sensors are
their common recommendation, apart from each class’ requirements.
Table 18.04.04: Shut down functions for AMS and UMS, option: 4 75 124
Local Instruments
The basic local instrumentation on the engine, options: 4 70 120 comprises thermometers, pressure gaug-
es and other indicators located on the piping or mounted on panels on the engine. The tables 18.05.01a, b
and c list those as well as sensors for slow down, alarm and remote indication, option: 4 75 127.
Lubricating oil
TI 8106 TE 8106 Thrust bearing segment
TE/TS 8107 Thrust bearing segment
TI 8112 TE 8112 Lubricating oil inlet to main engine
TI 8113 TE 8113 Piston cooling oil outlet/cylinder
Lubricating oil outlet from turbocharger/turbocharger
TI 8117 TE 8117
(depends on turbocharger design)
TE 8123 Main bearing oil outlet temperature/main bearing (Only engine types 42-26)
Scavenge air
TI 8605 TE 8605 Scavenge air before air cooler/air cooler
TI 8608 TE 8608 Scavenge air after air cooler/air cooler
TI 8609 TE 8609 Scavenge air receiver
TE 8610 Scavenge air box – fire alarm, cylinder/cylinder
Table 18.05.01a: Local thermometers on engine, option 4 70 120, and remote indication sensors, option: 4 75 127
Lubricating oil
PI 8103 PT 8103 Lubricating oil inlet to turbocharger/turbocharger
PI 8108 PT 8108 Lubricating oil inlet to main engine
PS/PT 8109 Lubricating oil inlet to main engine and thrust bearing
Cylinder lubrication
PT 8201 Cylinder lubrication oil inlet pressure (Alpha lubricator)
PDI 8206 Pressure drop across filter
Compressed air
PI 8501 PT 8501 I Starting air inlet to main starting valve
PI 8503 PT 8503 I Control air inlet
PI 8504 PT 8504 Safety air inlet
PT 8505 Air inlet to air cylinder for exhaust valve
Scavenge air
PI 8601 PT 8601 Scavenge air receiver (PI 8601 instrument same as PI 8706)
PS 8604 Scavenge air receiver, auxiliary blower failure
PDI 8606 Pressure drop of air across cooler/air cooler
PI 8613 PT 8613 Pressure compressor scroll housing/turbocharger (NA type)
PDI 8614 PDT 8614 Pressure drop across compressor scroll housing/turbocharger (NA type)
Exhaust gas
PI 8706 Exhaust gas receiver/Exhaust gas outlet turbocharger
Miscellaneous functions
PI 8803 Air inlet for dry cleaning of turbocharger
PI 8804 Water inlet for cleaning of turbocharger
Table 18.05.01b: Local pressure gauges on engine, option: 4 70 120, and remote indication sensors, option: 4 75 127
Lubricating oil
FS 8114 Piston cooling oil outlet/cylinder
Scavenge air
LS 8611 Water mist catcher – water level
Miscellaneous functions
ST 8801 I Turbocharger speed/turbocharger
WI 8812 WT 8812 Axial vibration monitor (For certain engines only, see note in Table 18.04.04)
(WI 8812 instrument is part of the transmitter WT 8812)
XS 8813 Oil mist in crankcase/cylinder
XS 8814 Oil mist detector failure
XC 8816 Shaftline earthing device
Table 18.05.01c: Other indicators on engine, option: 4 70 120, and remote indication sensors, option: 4 75 127
Drain box for fuel oil leakage alarm For all types of error situations detected by the
different bearing condition monitoring systems
Any leakage from the fuel oil high pressure pipes applies that in addition to damaging the compo-
of any cylinder is drained to a common drain box nents, in extreme cases, a risk of a crankcase
fitted with a level alarm. This is included for both explosion exists.
AMS and UMS.
In order to achieve a response to damage faster The EoD lists three alternative oil mist detectors:
than possible with Oil Mist Detection and Bearing
Temperature Monitoring alone we introduce Bear- 4 75 161 Oil mist detector Graviner MK6.
ing Wear Monitoring (BWM) systems. By monitor- Make: Kidde Fire Protection
ing the actual bearing wear continuously, mechani- 4 75 163 Oil mist detector Visatron VN 215/93.
cal damage to the crank-train bearings (main-, Make: Schaller
crank- and crosshead bearings) can be predicted 4 75 165 Oil mist detector QMI
in time to react and avoid damaging the journal Make: Quality Monitoring Instruments Ltd
and bearing housing.
If the oil supply to a main bearing fails, the bearing Diagrams for two of them are shown in Figs.
temperature will rise and in such a case a Bear- 18.06.01a and 18.06.01b.
ing Temperature Monitoring system will trigger
an alarm before wear actually takes place. For
that reason the ultimate protection against severe
bearing damage and the optimum way of provid-
ing early warning, is a combined bearing wear and
temperature monitoring system.
83ææææ!(ææ#ææ9,
#ABLES *UNCTIONæBOX
$ETECTORæHEAD
178 49 809.2
Fig. 18.06.01a: Oil mist detector pipes on engine, type Graviner MK6 from Kidde Fire Protection (EoD: 4 75 161)
83ææææ!(ææ#ææ9,
$RIVINGæAIRæCONNECTION
3IPHONçBLOCK
%XHAUSTæAIRæCONNECTIONæTOæCRANKæSPACE
178 49 810.2
Fig. 18.06.01b: Oil mist detector pipes on engine, type Visatron VN215/93 from Schaller (EoD: 4 75 163)
The Bearing Wear Monitoring (BWM) system mon- In case the oil system becomes contaminated with
itors all three principal crank-train bearings using an amount of water exceeding our limit of 0.2%
two proximity sensors forward/aft per cylinder (0.5% for short periods), acute corrosive wear of
unit and placed inside the frame box. the crosshead bearing overlayer may occur. The
higher the water content, the faster the wear rate.
Targeting the guide shoe bottom ends continu-
ously, the sensors measure the distance to the To prevent water from accumulating in the lube
crosshead in Bottom Dead Center (BDC). Signals oil and, thereby, causing damage to the bearings,
are computed and digitally presented to computer the oil should be monitored manually or automati-
hardware, from which a useable and easily inter- cally by means of a Water In Oil (WIO) monitoring
pretable interface is presented to the user. system connected to the engine alarm and moni-
toring system. In case of water contamination
The measuring precision is more than adequate to the source should be found and the equipment
obtain an alarm well before steel-to-steel contact inspected and repaired accordingly.
in the bearings occur. Also the long-term stability
of the measurements has shown to be excellent. The WIO system should trigger an alarm when
the water content exceeds 0.3%, and preferably
In fact, BWM is expected to provide long-term again when exceeding 0.5% measured as abso-
wear data at better precision and reliability than lute water content.
the manual vertical clearance measurements nor-
mally performed by the crew during regular serv- Some WIO systems measure water activity, ie
ice checks. the relative availability of water in a substance
expressed in aw on a scale from 0 to 1. Here, ‘0’
For the above reasons, we consider unscheduled indicates oil totally free of water and ‘1’ oil fully
open-up inspections of the crank-train bearings to saturated by water. The correlation to absolute
be superfluous, given BWM has been installed. water content in normal running as well as alarm
condition is as follows:
Two BWM ‘high wear’ alarm levels including devi-
ation alarm apply. The first level of the high wear / Engine condition Abs. water Water
deviation alarm is indicated in the alarm panel only content, % activity, wa
while the second level also activates a slow down. Normal running 0 - 0.2 0 - 0.7
Low alarm level 0.3 0.8
The Extent of Delivery lists four Bearing Wear High alarm level 0.5 1.0
Monitoring options of which the two systems from
Dr. E. Horn and Kongsberg could also include K98MC6/7, S42MC7, S35MC7, L35MC6 and
Bearing Temperature Monitoring: S26MC6 as well as all MC-C engines are as
standard specified with Water In Oil monitoring
4 75 142 Bearing Wear Monitoring System XTSW. system.
Make: AMOT
Please note: Corrosion of the overlayer is a poten-
4 75 143 Bearing Wear Monitoring System BDMS.
tial problem only for crosshead bearings, because
Make: Dr. E. Horn
only crosshead bearings are designed with an
4 75 144 Bearing Wear Monitoring System PS-10. overlayer. Main and crankpin bearings may also
Make: Kongsberg suffer irreparable damage from water contamina-
4 75 147 Bearing Wear Monitoring System OPEN- tion, but the damage mechanism would be differ-
predictor. Make: Rovsing ent and not as acute.
Control Devices
The control devices mainly include a position switch (ZS) or a position transmitter (ZT) and solenoid valves
(ZV) which are listed in Table 18.06.02 below. The sensor identification codes are listed in Table 18.07.01.
Fuel oil
ZV 8020 C Fuel oil cut-off at engine inlet (shut down), Germanischer Lloyd only
Scavenge air
PS 8603 C Scavenge air receiver, auxiliary blower control
19
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 19.01
Page 1 of 2
The dispatch patterns are divided into two class- The approximate masses of the sections appear
es, see Section 19.03: in Section 19.04. The masses can vary up to 10%
depending on the design and options chosen.
A: Short distance transportation and short term
storage Lifting tools and lifting instructions are required for all
B: Overseas or long distance transportation or levels of dispatch pattern. The lifting tools (4 12 110
long term storage. or 4 12 111), are to be specified when ordering and it
should be agreed whether the tools are to be returned
Short distance transportation (A) is limited by a to the engine maker (4 12 120) or not (4 12 121).
duration of a few days from delivery ex works until
installation, or a distance of approximately 1,000 MAN Diesel’s recommendations for preservation
km and short term storage. of disassembled/ assembled engines are avail-
able on request.
The duration from engine delivery until installation
must not exceed 8 weeks. Furthermore, it must be considered whether a
drying machine, option 4 12 601, is to be installed
Dismantling of the engine is limited as much as during the transportation and/or storage period.
possible.
MAN Diesel’s recommendations for shop trial, Large spare parts, dimensions and masses
quay trial and sea trial are available on request.
The approximate dimensions and masses of the
An additional test is required for measuring the NOx larger spare parts are indicated in Section 19.09.
emissions, for plants with FPP or CPP, EoD 4 06 A complete list will be delivered by the engine
060a or 4 06 060b respectively. maker.
Spare Parts
Tools
List of spares, unrestricted service
List of standard tools
The tendency today is for the classification societ-
ies to change their rules such that required spare The engine is delivered with the necessary special
parts are changed into recommended spare tools for overhauling purposes. The extent, di-
parts. mensions and masses of the main tools is stated
in Section 19.10. A complete list will be delivered
MAN Diesel, however, has decided to keep a by the engine maker.
set of spare parts included in the basic extent
of delivery (4 87 601) covering the requirements Tool Panels
and recommendations of the major classification
societies, see Section 19.06. Most of the tools are arranged on steel plate pan-
els (EoD 4 88 660) see Section 19.11 ‘Tool Panels’.
This amount is to be considered as minimum
safety stock for emergency situations. It is recommended to place the panels close to the
location where the overhaul is to be carried out.
Additional spare parts recommended by
MAN Diesel
Wearing parts
Note: All paints are to be of good quality. Paints according to builder‘s standard may be used provided they at least
fulfil the above requirements.
The data stated are only to be considered as guidelines. Preparation, number of coats, film thickness per coat,
etc. have to be in accordance with the paint manufacturer’s specifications.
178 30 207.4
Dispatch Pattern
The relevant engine supplier is responsible for the
actual execution and delivery extent. As differenc- !¬¬"
es may appear in the individual suppliers’ extent
and dispatch variants.
4OP¬SECTION
"EDPLATECRANKSHAFT
Fig. 19.03.01a : Dispatch pattern, engine with turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122) SECTION
&RAME¬BOX¬SECTION
4OP¬SECTION "OTTOM
A3 + B3 (option 4 12 023 + 4 12 033)
• Top section including cylinder frame complete,
!¬¬"
cylinder covers complete, scavenge air re-
ceiver including cooler box and cooler insert,
turbocharger(s), camshaft, piston rods complete
and galleries with pipes.
• Frame box section including frame box com-
plete, chain drive connecting rods and galleries.
• Bedplate/crankshaft section including bedplate
complete, crankshaft complete with wheels and
turning gear.
4OP¬SECTION
• Remaining parts, stay bolts, chains, etc.
Note!
%XHAUST¬RECEIVER
The engine supplier is responsible4URBOCHARGER
for the neces-
sary lifting tools and lifting instructions for trans-
4OP¬SECTION
portation purpose to the yard. 3CAVENGE¬AIR¬RECEIVER
%XHAUST¬RECEIVER 4URBOCHARGER
"EDPLATE¬SECTION #RANKSHAFT¬SECTION
&RAME¬BOX¬SECTION !IR¬COOLER¬BOX
178 59 52-8.0
Fig. 19.03.01b: Dispatch pattern, engine with turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)
"EDPLATE¬SECTION #RANKSHAFT¬SECTION
MAN B&W 19.04
Page 1 of 1
Available on request
Frame box section 72.8 8.9 81.7 9.9 89.1 11.0 98.7 12.1 3.5 5.2
A3+B3
Bedplate/Crankshaft 120.5 7.5 116.4 8.6 136.0 9.7 150.4 10.7 3.2 3.5
Remaining parts 14.0 15.0 16.0 17.0
Top section 89.5 8.0 106.2 9.1 122.9 10.1 139.6 11.2 4.2 3.9
Exhaust receiver 6.4 6.6 7.4 7.6 8.4 8.7 9.4 9.8 2.1 2.2
Scavenge air receiver 14.8 8.0 16.4 9.1 19.5 10.1 21.2 11.2 3.3 3.6
Turbocharger, each 5.4 5.4 9.8 9.8
A4+B4 Air cooler, each 4.1 4.2 4.6 4.7
Frame box section 73.1 8.9 82.0 9.9 89.3 11.0 98.9 12.1 3.5 5.2
Crankshaft 76.7 7.3 67.3 8.4 81.7 9.4 90.9 10.5 3.0 3.0
Bedplate 43.5 7.2 48.7 8.3 53.9 9.3 59.1 10.4 3.2 3.5
Remaining parts 14.3 15.4 16.4 17.5
The weights stated are for standard engines with semibuilt crankshaft with forged throws, crosshead guides inte-
grated in the frame box, and MAN Diesel turbocharger. All masses and dimensions in the dispatch pattern are there-
fore approximate and do not include packing and lifting tools. The masses of turning wheel, turbocharger specified in
dispatch pattern outline can vary, and should be checked. Moment compensator and turning wheel are not included
in dispatch pattern outline. Turning wheel is supposed to be of 22 ton (5 cyl.) and 4,5 ton (6, 7 and 8 cyl.).
Shop test
• Starting and manoeuvring test at no load An additional test may be required for obtaining
• Load test the ‘Engine Prevention’ Certificate, which states
Engine to be started and run up to 50% of that the engine complies with IMO NOx emission
Specified MCR (M) in 1 hour limitations 4 06 060.
• Governor test
• Minimum speed test
• Overspeed test
• Shut down test
• Starting and reversing test
• Turning gear blocking device test
• Start, stop and reversing from the Local
Operating Panel (LOP)
Spare parts are requested by the following Classes 1 Guide ring 2/2 for camshaft bearing
only: GL, KR, NK and RS, while just recommended by:
ABS, DNV and LR, but neither requested nor recom- Starting valve, plate 907
mended by: BV, CCS and RINA. 1 Starting valve, complete
Chain drive, plate 906 1) a) Only required for RS. To be ordered separately as
1 Of each type of bearings for camshaft at chain option: 4 87 660 for other classification societies.
drive, chain tightener and intermediate shaft
6 Camshaft chain links. Only for ABS, DNV, LR, Please note: Plate number refers to Instruction Book,
NK and RS Vol. III containing plates with spare parts.
1 Mechanically driven cylinder lubricator drive: 6
chain links or gear wheels
Additional Spares
For easier maintenance and increased security in operation
Cylinder cover, section 90101 Cylinder Lubricating Oil System, section 90306
4 Studs for exhaust valve 1 set Spares for MAN B&W Alpha lubricating oil
4 Nuts for exhaust valve system for 1cyl.
½ set Orings for cooling jacket 1 Lubricator
1 Cooling jacket 2 Feed back sensor, complete
½ set Sealing between cyl.cover and liner 1 Complete sets of Orings for lubricator
4 Spring housings for fuel valv (depending on No. of lubricating nozzles per.
cylinder)
Hydraulic tool for cylinder cover, section 90161
1 set Hydraulic hoses with protection hose Connecting rod and crosshead, section 90401
complete with couplings 1 Telescopic pipe
8 pcs Orings with backup rings, upper 2 Thrust piece
8 pcs Orings with backup rings, lower
HPS Hydaulic Power Supply, section 906
Piston and piston rod, section 90201 1 Delivery pump
1 box Locking wire, L=63 m 1 Start up pump
5 Piston rings of each kind 1 Pressure relief valve
2 Drings for piston skirt 1 Pumps short cutting valve
2 Drings for piston rod 1 set Check valve Cartridge (3 pcs)
Piston rod stuffing box, section 90205 Engine Control System, section 906
15 Self locking nuts 1 set Fuses for MPC, TSA, CNR
5 Orings 1 Segment for triggerring
5 Top scraper rings
15 Pack sealing rings HCU Hydraulic Cylinder Unit, section 906
10 Cover sealing rings 1 set Packings
120 Lamellas for scraper rings
30 Springs for top scraper and sealing rings Main starting valve, section 90702
20 Springs for scraper rings 1 Repair kit for main actuator
1 Repair kit for main ball valve
Cylinder frame, section 90301 1 *) Repair kit for actuator, slow turning
½ set Studs for cylinder cover for one cyl. 1 *) Repair kit for ball valve, slow turning
1 Bushing
*) if fitted
Cylinder liner and cooling jacket, section 90302
1 Cooling jacket of each kind Starting valve, section 90704
4 Non return valves 2 Locking plates
1 set Orings for one cylinder liner 2 Piston
½ set Gaskets for cooling water connection 2 Spring
½ set Orings for cooling water pipes 2 Bushing
1 set Cooling water pipes between liner and cover 1 set Oring
for one cylinder 1 Valve spindle
Note:
Section numbers refers to Instruction Book, Vol. III containing plates with spareparts
Fig. 19.07.01a: Additional spare parts beyond class requirements or recommendation, for easier maintenance and
increased availability, option: 4 87 603
Exhaust valve, section 90801 Fuel oil high pressure pipes, section 90913
1 Exhaust valve spindle 1 High pressure pipe, from fuel oil pressure
1 Exhaust valve seat booster to fuel valve
½ set Oring exhaust valve/cylinder cover 1 High pressure pipe from actuator to exhaust
4 Piston rings valve
½ set Guide rings 1 set Orings for high pressure pipes
½ set Sealing rings
½ set Safety valves Overflow valve, section 90915
1 set Gaskets and Orings for safety valve 1 Overflow valve, complete
1 Piston complete 1 Orings of each kind
1 Damper piston
1 set Orings and sealings between air piston and Turbocharger, section 91000
exhaust valve housing/spindle 1 Spare rotor, complete with bearings
1 Liner for spindle guide 1 Spare part set for turbocharger
1 set Gaskets and Orings for cool.w.conn.
1 Conical ring in 2/2 Scavenge air receiver, section 91001
1 set Orings for spindle/air piston 2 Nonreturn valves complete
1 set Nonreturn valve 1 Compensator
Exhaust valve, section 908 Exhaust pipes and receiver, section 91003
1 Sealing oil unit 1 Compensator between TC and receiver
2 Compensator between exhaust valve and re-
Exhaust valve actuator, section 90805 ceiver
1 Hydraulic exhaust valve actuator complete for 1 set Gaskets for each compensator
1 cylinder
1 Electronic exhaust valve control valve Air cooler, section 91005
16 Iron blocks (Corrosion blocks)
Cooling water outlet, section 90810
2 Ball valve Safety valve, section 91101
1 Butterfly valve 1 set Gasket for safety valve
1 Compensator 2 Safety valve, complete
1 set Gaskets for butterfly valve and compensator
Arrangement of safety cap, section 91104
Fuel injection system, section 90901 1 set Bursting disc
1 Fuel oil pressure booster complete, for 1 cyl.
1 Hydraulic cylinder unit Engine Lubricating System, section 912
1 set Gaskets and sealings 1 set 10 µ filter
1 Electronic fuel injection cotrol valve
Fig. 19.07.01b: Additional spare parts beyond class requirements or recommendation, for easier maintenance and
increased availability, option: 4 87 603
Wearing Parts
Table A
Group No. Section Qty. Descriptions
1 90101 50% O-rings and gaskets for 1 cylinder
2 25% Spring housing, complete for 1 cylinder
3 90161 50% O-ring W / Back-up ring for 1 cylinder
4 50% Hose with union for 1 cylinder
5 90201 1 Box Locking wire 1,0MM L=63
100% Piston rings for 1 cylinder
100% O-rings for 1 cylinder
6 90205 100% O-rings for 1 cylinder
100% Lamella rings 3/3 for 1 cylinder
50% Top scraper rings 4/4 for 1 cylinder
50% Pack Sealing rings 4/4 for 1 cylinder
50% Cover Sealing rings 4/4 for 1 cylinder
50% Springs of each kind for 1 cylinder
7 90302 50% O-rings / Sealing rings for Cylinder liner
100% O-rings, Packings and Gaskets for cooling water connections
8 1Pcs Cylinder liner
1Pcs Piston cleaning ring (if Mounted)
9 90610 50% Bearing Shells and Guide Disc for 1 Engine
10 90612 100% Packings and Gaskets for 1 Engine
25% Indicator valves for 1 Engine
11 90615-25 25% Pull-rods for 1 Engine
12 90702 50% Repair Kit for each type of valve for 1 Engine
13 90704 100% O-rings, Packings and Gaskets for 1 Engine
14 90801 25% Exhaust valve spindle for 1 Engine
25% Exhaust valve W-bottom piece for 1 Engine
15 100% Piston rings for exhaust valve air piston and oil piston for 1 Engine
100% O-rings for water connections for 1 Engine
100% Gasket for cooling for water connections for 1 Engine
100% O-rings for oil connections for 1 Engine
1 Pcs Spindle guide
2 Pcs Air sealing ring
50% Guide sealing rings
100% O-rings for bottom piece for 1 Engine
17 90901 25% Plunger and barrel for fuel pump for 1 Engine
50% Suction valve complete / puncture valve,complete for 1 Cylinder
100% Sealing rings, O-rings and Gaskets for 1 cylinder
18 90910 50% Fuel valve nozzle for 1 cylinder
25% Spindle guide complete and non-return valve for 1 cylinder
200% O-rings for 1 cylinder
19 91000 1 Slide bearing for turbocharger for 1 engine (roller bearings)
1 Guide bearing for turbocharger for 1 engine (roller bearings)
20 91000 1 Slide bearing for turbocharger for 1 engine (slide bearings)
1 Guide bearing for turbocharger for 1 engine (slide bearings)
198 99 90-3.1
The wearing parts are divided into 20 groups, In order to find the expected consumption for a 6
each including the components stated in table A. cylinder engine during the first 18000 hours’ serv-
ice, the extent stated for each group in table A is
The average expected consumption of wearing to be multiplied by the figures stated in the table
parts is stated in tables B for 1, 2, 3... 10 years’ B (see the arrow), for the cylinder No. and service
service of a new engine, a service year being as- hours in question.
sumed to be of 6000 hours.
Table B
Group
No. Service hours 0-6000 0-12000
Number of cylinders
Description 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
1 O-rings and gaskets 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
2 Spring housing 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
3 O-ring W / Back-up ring 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
4 Hose with union 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
5 Set of piston rings 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
6 St. box, lamella / sealing rings 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
7 O-rings / Sealing rings Cyl. liner 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
8 Cylinder liners 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
9 Bearing Shells and Guide Disc 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
10 Packings and Gaskets 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
11 Pull-rods 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
12 Repair Kit for each type of valve 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
13 O-rings, Packings and Gaskets 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
14 Exhaust valve spindles / bottom pieces 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
15 Exhaust valve guide bushings 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
O-rings for exhaust valve 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
17 Fuel pump plungers 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Suction/puncture valves , Sealing rings and
0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
Gaskets
18 Fuel valve guides and nozzles 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
19 Set bearings per TC (roller bearings) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
20 Set bearings per TC (slide bearings) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
178 24 92-2.1
Table 19.08.01b: Wearing parts, option 4 87 629
Table B
Group
No. Service hours 0-18000 0-24000
Number of cylinders
Description 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
1 O-rings and gaskets 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
2 Spring housing 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
3 O-ring W / Back-up ring 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
4 Hose with union 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
5 Set of piston rings 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
6 St. box, lamella / sealing rings 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
7 O-rings / Sealing rings Cyl. liner 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
8 Cylinder liners 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
9 Bearing Shells and Guide Disc 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
10 Packings and Gaskets 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
11 Pull-rods 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
12 Repair Kit for each type of valve 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
13 O-rings, Packings and Gaskets 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
14 Exhaust valve spindles / bottom pieces 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
15 Exhaust valve guide bushings 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
O-rings for exhaust valve 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
17 Fuel pump plungers 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Suction/puncture valves , Sealing rings and
4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
Gaskets
18 Fuel valve guides and nozzles 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
19 Set bearings per TC (roller bearings) 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2
20 Set bearings per TC (slide bearings) 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1
178 24 92-2.1
Table 19.08.01c: Wearing parts, option 4 87 629
Table B
Group
No. Service hours 0-30000 0-36000
Number of cylinders
Description 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
1 O-rings and gaskets 20 25 30 35 40 24 30 36 42 48
2 Spring housing 8 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
3 O-ring W / Back-up ring 20 25 30 35 40 24 30 36 42 48
4 Hose with union 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
5 Set of piston rings 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
6 St. box, lamella / sealing rings 8 10 12 14 16 12 15 18 21 24
7 O-rings / Sealing rings Cyl. liner 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
8 Cylinder liners 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
9 Bearing Shells and Guide Disc 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
10 Packings and Gaskets 20 25 30 35 40 24 30 36 42 48
11 Pull-rods 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
12 Repair Kit for each type of valve 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
13 O-rings, Packings and Gaskets 20 25 30 35 40 24 30 36 42 48
14 Exhaust valve spindles / bottom pieces 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
15 Exhaust valve guide bushings 8 10 12 14 16 16 20 24 28 32
O-rings for exhaust valve 20 25 30 35 40 24 30 36 42 48
17 Fuel pump plungers 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 6 7 8
Suction/puncture valves , Sealing rings and
8 10 12 14 16 12 15 18 21 24
Gaskets
18 Fuel valve guides and nozzles 16 20 24 28 32 16 20 24 28 32
19 Set bearings per TC (roller bearings) 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3 3
20 Set bearings per TC (slide bearings) 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
178 24 92-2.1
Table 19.08.01d: Wearing parts, option 4 87 629
Table B
Group
Service hours 0-42000 0-48000
No.
Number of cylinders
Description 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
1 O-rings and gaskets 28 35 42 49 56 32 40 48 56 64
2 Spring housing 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
3 O-ring W / Back-up ring 28 35 42 49 56 32 40 48 56 64
4 Hose with union 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
5 Set of piston rings 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
6 St. box, lamella / sealing rings 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
7 O-rings / Sealing rings Cyl. liner 8 10 12 14 16 16 20 24 28 32
8 Cylinder liners 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
9 Bearing Shells and Guide Disc 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
10 Packings and Gaskets 28 35 42 49 56 32 40 48 56 64
11 Pull-rods 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
12 Repair Kit for each type of valve 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
13 O-rings, Packings and Gaskets 28 35 42 49 56 32 40 48 56 64
14 Exhaust valve spindles / bottom pieces 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
15 Exhaust valve guide bushings 8 10 12 14 16 16 20 24 28 32
O-rings for exhaust valve 28 35 42 49 56 32 40 48 56 64
17 Fuel pump plungers 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
Suction/puncture valves , Sealing rings and
12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
Gaskets
18 Fuel valve guides and nozzles 20 25 30 35 40 20 25 30 35 40
19 Set bearings per TC (roller bearings) 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 4 4 4
20 Set bearings per TC (slide bearings) 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2
178 24 92-2.1
Table 19.08.01e: Wearing parts, option 4 87 629
Table B
Group
No. Service hours 0-54000 0-60000
Number of cylinders
Description 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
1 O-rings and gaskets 36 45 54 63 72 40 50 60 70 80
2 Spring housing 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
3 O-ring W / Back-up ring 36 45 54 63 72 40 50 60 70 80
4 Hose with union 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
5 Set of piston rings 16 20 24 28 32 16 20 24 28 32
6 St. box, lamella / sealing rings 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
7 O-rings / Sealing rings Cyl. liner 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
8 Cylinder liners 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
9 Bearing Shells and Guide Disc 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
10 Packings and Gaskets 28 35 42 49 56 32 40 48 56 64
11 Pull-rods 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
12 Repair Kit for each type of valve 12 15 18 21 24 16 20 24 28 32
13 O-rings, Packings and Gaskets 36 45 54 63 72 40 50 60 70 80
14 Exhaust valve spindles / bottom pieces 4 5 6 7 8 8 10 12 14 16
15 Exhaust valve guide bushings 8 10 12 14 16 16 20 24 28 32
O-rings for exhaust valve 36 45 54 63 72 40 50 60 70 80
17 Fuel pump plungers 4 5 6 7 8 4 5 6 7 8
Suction/puncture valves , Sealing rings and
12 15 18 21 24 12 15 18 21 24
Gaskets
18 Fuel valve guides and nozzles 12 15 18 21 24 12 15 18 21 24
19 Set bearings per TC (roller bearings) 4 4 4 4 4 5 5 5 5 5
20 Set bearings per TC (slide bearings) 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
178 24 92-2.1
Table 19.08.01f: Wearing parts, option 4 87 629
! !
"
"
#
# ! $
"
$ # %
"
!
" !
178 51 597.1
Tool Panels
20
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 20.01
Page of 1
Extent of Delivery
The ‘Extent of Delivery’ (EoD) sheets have been Diesel engine
compiled in order to facilitate communication be- 4 30 xxx Diesel engine
tween owner, consultants, yard and engine maker 4 31 xxx Vibrations and balancing
during the project stage, regarding the scope of 4 35 xxx Fuel oil piping
supply and the alternatives (options) available for 4 40 xxx Lubricating oil and control oil piping
MAN B&W twostroke engines. 4 42 xxx Cylinder lubricating oil piping
4 43 xxx Piston rod stuffing box drain piping
We provide four different EoDs: 4 45 xxx Low temperature cooling water piping
4 46 xxx Jacket cooling water piping
EoD 98 50 MC Type Engine 4 50 xxx Starting and control air piping
EoD 46 26 MC Type Engines 4 54 xxx Scavenge air cooler
EoD 108 50 ME Type Engines 4 55 xxx Scavenge air piping
EoD 50 35 ME-B Type Engines 4 59 xxx Turbocharger
4 60 xxx Exhaust gas piping
These publications are available at: 4 65 xxx Engine control system
www.mandiesel.com 4 70 xxx Local instrumentation
under ‘Marine’ → ‘Low speed’ → 4 75 xxx Monitoring, safety, alarm and
‘Project Guides and Extent of Delivery (EOD)’ remote indication
4 78 xxx Electrical wiring on engine
This includes:
When a final contract is signed, a complete set of Main Section 901 Engine data
documentation, in the following called ‘Installation External forces and moments
Documentation’, will be supplied to the buyer by Guide force moments
the engine maker. Water and oil in engine
Centre of gravity
The ‘Installation Documentation’ is normally di- Basic symbols for piping
vided into the ‘A’ and ‘B’ volumes mentioned in Instrument symbols for piping
the ‘Extent of Delivery’ under items: Balancing
Main Section 917 Engine room crane Main Section 931 Top bracing of engine
Engine room crane capacity, overhauling space Top bracing outline
Top bracing arrangement
Main Section 918 Torsiograph arrangement Frictionmaterials
Torsiograph arrangement Top bracing instructions
Top bracing forces
Main Section 919 Shaft earthing device Top bracing tension data
Earthing device
Main Section 932 Shaft line
Main Section 920 Fire extinguishing in Static thrust shaft load
scavenge air space Fitted bolt
Fire extinguishing in scavenge air space
Main Section 933 Power TakeOff
Main Section 921 Instrumentation List of capacities
Axial vibration monitor PTO/RCF arrangement, if fitted
Main Section 926 Engine seating Main Section 936 Spare parts dimensions
Profile of engine seating Connecting rod studs
Epoxy chocks Cooling jacket
Alignment screws Crankpin bearing shell
Crosshead bearing
Main Section 927 Holdingdown bolts Cylinder cover stud
Holdingdown bolt Cylinder cover
Round nut Cylinder liner
Distance pipe Exhaust valve
Spherical washer Exhaust valve bottom piece
Spherical nut Exhaust valve spindle
Assembly of holdingdown bolt Exhaust valve studs
Protecting cap Fuel valve
Arrangement of holdingdown bolts Main bearing shell
Main bearing studs
Main Section 928 Supporting chocks Piston complete
Supporting chocks Starting valve
Securing of supporting chocks Telescope pipe
Thrust block segment
Main Section 929 Side chocks Turbocharger rotor
Side chocks
Liner for side chocks, starboard Main Section 940 Gaskets, sealings, Orings
Liner for side chocks, port side Gaskets, sealings, Orings
Main Section 930 End chocks Main Section 949 Material sheets
Stud for end chock bolt MAN B&W Standard Sheets Nos:
End chock
Round nut • S19R
Spherical washer, concave • S45R
Spherical washer, convex • S25Cr1
Assembly of end chock bolt • S34Cr1R
Liner for end chock • C4
Protecting cap
Appendix
A
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Appendix A
Page of 3
1.2 Pipe with indication of direction of flow 2.16 Bulkhead crossing, nonwatertight
1.3 Valves, gate valves, cocks and flaps 2.17 Pipe going upwards
2 Pipes and pipe joints 3 Valves, gate valves, cocks and flaps
2.5 Expansion pipe (corrugated) general 3.5 Nonreturn valve (flap), angle
The symbols used are in accordance with ISO/R 5381967, except symbol No. 2.19
178 30 614.1